blob: f2954a846d717c4d2ac281eef4d6b3c96b94a7fb [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreaufba74ea2018-12-22 11:19:45 +01005 version 2.0
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau6e893b92019-03-26 05:40:51 +01007 2019/03/26
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020054
554. Proxies
564.1. Proxy keywords matrix
574.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
58
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100595. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200605.1. Bind options
615.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200625.3. Server DNS resolution
635.3.1. Global overview
645.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020065
666. HTTP header manipulation
67
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200687. Using ACLs and fetching samples
697.1. ACL basics
707.1.1. Matching booleans
717.1.2. Matching integers
727.1.3. Matching strings
737.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
747.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
757.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
767.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
777.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200787.3.1. Converters
797.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
807.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
817.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
827.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
837.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200847.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085
868. Logging
878.1. Log levels
888.2. Log formats
898.2.1. Default log format
908.2.2. TCP log format
918.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100928.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100938.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200948.3. Advanced logging options
958.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
968.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
978.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
988.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
998.4. Timing events
1008.5. Session state at disconnection
1018.6. Non-printable characters
1028.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1038.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1048.9. Examples of logs
105
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001069. Supported filters
1079.1. Trace
1089.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001099.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001109.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200111
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010011210. Cache
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010011310.1. Limitation
11410.2. Setup
11510.2.1. Cache section
11610.2.2. Proxy section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117
1181. Quick reminder about HTTP
119----------------------------
120
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100121When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
123on almost anything found in the contents.
124
125However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
126formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
127correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
128
129
1301.1. The HTTP transaction model
131-------------------------------
132
133The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100134to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100135from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
136connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200137will involve a new connection :
138
139 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
140
141In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
142establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
143by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
144length.
145
146Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
147to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
148however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
149response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
150header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
151
152 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
153
154Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
155power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
156but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200157a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100159Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200160keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
161second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
162page :
163
164 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
165
166This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
167latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
168correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
169the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100170server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100172The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
173time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
174are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
175parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
176carry the stream identifier.
177
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100178By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
179connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
180leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100181start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
182processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
183waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200184
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200185HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100186 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
187 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100188 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100189 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200190 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100191
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100192For HTTP/2, the connection mode resembles more the "server close" mode : given
193the independence of all streams, there is currently no place to hook the idle
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100194server connection after a response, so it is closed after the response. HTTP/2
195is only supported for incoming connections, not on connections going to
196servers.
197
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200198
1991.2. HTTP request
200-----------------
201
202First, let's consider this HTTP request :
203
204 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100205 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
207 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
208 3 User-agent: my small browser
209 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
210 5 Accept: image/png
211
212
2131.2.1. The Request line
214-----------------------
215
216Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
217
218 - a METHOD : GET
219 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
220 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
221
222All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
223which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
224followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
225is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
226desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
227the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
228
229The URI itself can have several forms :
230
231 - A "relative URI" :
232
233 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
234
235 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
236 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
237
238 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
239
240 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
241
242 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
243 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
244 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
245 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
246 must accept this form too.
247
248 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
249 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
250 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100251
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200252 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
253 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
254 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
255 other protocols too.
256
257In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
258mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
259on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
260It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
261specific to the language, framework or application in use.
262
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100263HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100264assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100265However, haproxy natively processes HTTP/1.x requests and headers, so requests
266received over an HTTP/2 connection are transcoded to HTTP/1.1 before being
267processed. This explains why they still appear as "HTTP/1.1" in haproxy's logs
268as well as in server logs.
269
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200270
2711.2.2. The request headers
272--------------------------
273
274The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
275beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
276an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
277Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
278values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
279encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
280the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
281define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
282
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100283Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200284their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100285"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
286as can be seen when running in debug mode.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200287
288The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
289that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
290is one valid form of empty line.
291
292Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
293headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
294about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
295application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
296
297Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000298 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200299 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
300 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
301 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
302
303
3041.3. HTTP response
305------------------
306
307An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
308messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
309
310 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100311 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200312 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
313 2 Content-length: 350
314 3 Content-Type: text/html
315
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200316As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
317codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
318response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100319continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
320the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
321following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
322sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
323(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
324correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
325such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
326state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
327over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
328if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
329information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200330
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200331
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003321.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200333------------------------
334
335Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
336
337 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
338 - a status code : 200
339 - a reason : OK
340
341The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100342 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
343 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
344 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
345 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
346 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200347
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000348Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100349"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200350found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
351messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
352or "Authentication Required".
353
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100354HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200355
356 Code When / reason
357 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
358 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
359 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
360 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100361 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
362 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200363 400 for an invalid or too large request
364 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
365 accessing the stats page)
366 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
367 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
368 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
369 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
370 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
371 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
372 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
373 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
374 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
375
376The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3774.2).
378
379
3801.3.2. The response headers
381---------------------------
382
383Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
384the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
385details.
386
387
3882. Configuring HAProxy
389----------------------
390
3912.1. Configuration file format
392------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200393
394HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
395
396 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
397 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
398 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
399 "frontend" and "backend".
400
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100401The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
402referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200403delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100404
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200405
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004062.2. Quoting and escaping
407-------------------------
408
409HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
410many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
411with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
412single quotes.
413
414If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
415them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
416escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
417
418Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
419
420 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
421 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
422 \\ to use a backslash
423 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
424 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
425
426Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
427the interpretation of:
428
429 space as a parameter separator
430 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
431 # hash as a comment start
432
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200433Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
434-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
435backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
436
437Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200438quoting.
439
440Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
441nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
442
443Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
444equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
445
446 Example:
447 # those are equivalents:
448 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
449 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
450 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
451 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
452 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
453
454 # those are equivalents:
455 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
456 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
457 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
458 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
459
460
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004612.3. Environment variables
462--------------------------
463
464HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
465interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
466configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
467optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
468shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
469underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
470
471 Example:
472
473 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
474
475 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
476
477 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
478
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200479A special variable $HAPROXY_LOCALPEER is defined at the startup of the process
480which contains the name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
481
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200482
4832.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200484----------------
485
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100486Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100487values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
488otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
489numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
490for every keyword. Supported units are :
491
492 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
493 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
494 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
495 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
496 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
497 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
498
499
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005002.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200501-------------
502
503 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
504 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
505 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
506 global
507 daemon
508 maxconn 256
509
510 defaults
511 mode http
512 timeout connect 5000ms
513 timeout client 50000ms
514 timeout server 50000ms
515
516 frontend http-in
517 bind *:80
518 default_backend servers
519
520 backend servers
521 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
522
523
524 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
525 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
526 global
527 daemon
528 maxconn 256
529
530 defaults
531 mode http
532 timeout connect 5000ms
533 timeout client 50000ms
534 timeout server 50000ms
535
536 listen http-in
537 bind *:80
538 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
539
540
541Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
542
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100543 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200544
545
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005463. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200547--------------------
548
549Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
550are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
551of them have command-line equivalents.
552
553The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
554
555 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200556 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200557 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200558 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200559 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200560 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200561 - description
562 - deviceatlas-json-file
563 - deviceatlas-log-level
564 - deviceatlas-separator
565 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900566 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200567 - gid
568 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100569 - hard-stop-after
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200570 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200571 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100572 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200573 - lua-load
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200574 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200575 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200576 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200577 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100578 - presetenv
579 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200580 - uid
581 - ulimit-n
582 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200583 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100584 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200585 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200586 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200587 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200588 - ssl-default-bind-options
589 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200590 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200591 - ssl-default-server-options
592 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100593 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100594 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100595 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100596 - 51degrees-data-file
597 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200598 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200599 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200600 - wurfl-data-file
601 - wurfl-information-list
602 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200603 - wurfl-cache-size
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100604
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200605 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200606 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200607 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200608 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100609 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100610 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100611 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200612 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200613 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200614 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200615 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200616 - noepoll
617 - nokqueue
618 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100619 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300620 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000621 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100622 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200623 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200624 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200625 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000626 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000627 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200628 - tune.buffers.limit
629 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200630 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200631 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100632 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200633 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200634 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200635 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100636 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200637 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200638 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100639 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100640 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100641 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100642 - tune.lua.session-timeout
643 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200644 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100645 - tune.maxaccept
646 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200647 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200648 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200649 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100650 - tune.rcvbuf.client
651 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100652 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200653 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100654 - tune.sndbuf.client
655 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100656 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100657 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200658 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100659 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200660 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200661 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100662 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200663 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100664 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200665 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
666 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
667 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100668 - tune.zlib.memlevel
669 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100670
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200671 * Debugging
672 - debug
673 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200674
675
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006763.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200677------------------------------------
678
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200679ca-base <dir>
680 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200681 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
682 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200683
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200684chroot <jail dir>
685 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
686 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
687 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
688 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
689 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100690 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100691
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100692cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
693 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
694 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
695 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
696 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
697 set. These sets have the format
698
699 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
700
701 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100702 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100703 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
704 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100705 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
706 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100707 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100708 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100709 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100710 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100711 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
712 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
713 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
714 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100715
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100716 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
717 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
718 on the machine's word size.
719
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100720 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100721 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
722 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
723 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
724 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
725 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
726 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100727
728 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100729 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
730
731 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
732 # first 4 CPUs
733
734 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
735 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
736 # word size.
737
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100738 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100739 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100740 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
741 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
742 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
743
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100744 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
745 # and so on.
746 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
747 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
748 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
749
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100750 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100751 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
752 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
753 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
754
755 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
756 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
757 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
758
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100759 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
760 # and a thread range.
761 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
762 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
763 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
764
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200765crt-base <dir>
766 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
767 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
768 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
769
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200770daemon
771 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
772 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100773 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
774 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200775
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200776deviceatlas-json-file <path>
777 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100778 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200779
780deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100781 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200782 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
783
784deviceatlas-separator <char>
785 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
786 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
787
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100788deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200789 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
790 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
791 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100792
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900793external-check
794 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
795 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
796 See "option external-check".
797
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200798gid <number>
799 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
800 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
801 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100802 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
803 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200804 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100805
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100806hard-stop-after <time>
807 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
808
809 Arguments :
810 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
811 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
812 SIGUSR1 signal.
813
814 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
815 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
816 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
817
818 Example:
819 global
820 hard-stop-after 30s
821
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200822group <group name>
823 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
824 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100825
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200826log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
827 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100828 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100829 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100830 configured with "log global".
831
832 <address> can be one of:
833
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100834 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100835 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
836 port).
837
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100838 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
839 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
840 port).
841
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100842 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100843 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
844 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100845 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100846
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100847 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
848 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
849 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
850 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
851 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
852 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
853 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
854 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
855 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
856 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
857 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
858 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
859 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
860 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100861 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
862 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100863
864 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
865 "fd@2", see above.
866
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200867 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
868 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100869
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200870 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
871 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
872 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
873 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
874 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
875 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
876 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
877 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
878 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
879 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100880 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
881 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200882
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200883 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
884 one of the following :
885
886 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
887 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
888
889 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
890 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
891
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +0100892 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
893 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
894 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
895 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
896 logger consumes.
897
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100898 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
899 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
900 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
901 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
902
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200903 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
904 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
905 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
906 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
907 set with <sample_size> parameter.
908
909 <sample_size>
910 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
911 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
912 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
913 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
914 (see also <ranges> parameter).
915
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100916 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200917
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +0100918 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
919 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
920 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
921
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100922 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
923 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
924 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
925 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200926
927 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200928 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
929 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
930 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
931 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
932 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
933 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200934
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200935 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200936
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100937log-send-hostname [<string>]
938 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
939 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
940 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
941 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
942 the logs.
943
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000944log-tag <string>
945 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
946 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
947 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100948 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000949
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100950lua-load <file>
951 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
952 used multiple times.
953
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100954master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200955 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
956 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
957 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100958 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200959 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
960 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100961 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
962 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
963 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
964 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
965 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200966
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100967 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200968
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200969nbproc <number>
970 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
971 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
972 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +0100973 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
974 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreau1f672a82019-01-26 14:20:55 +0100975 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon" and
976 "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200977
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200978nbthread <number>
979 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +0100980 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
981 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
982 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
983 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
984 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +0100985 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
986 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
987 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
988 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
989 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
990 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
991 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200992
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200993pidfile <pidfile>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100994 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200995 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
996 starting the process. See also "daemon".
997
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100998presetenv <name> <value>
999 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1000 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1001 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1002 and "unsetenv".
1003
1004resetenv [<name> ...]
1005 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1006 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1007 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1008 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1009 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1010 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1011 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1012 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1013
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001014stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001015 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1016 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1017 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1018 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1019 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1020 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001021 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001022 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1023 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1024 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1025 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001026
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001027server-state-base <directory>
1028 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001029 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1030 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001031
1032server-state-file <file>
1033 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1034 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1035 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1036 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1037 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1038 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1039 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1040 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001041 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1042 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001043
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001044setenv <name> <value>
1045 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1046 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1047 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1048 and "unsetenv".
1049
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001050set-dumpable
1051 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
1052 developer's request. It has no impact on performance nor stability but will
1053 try hard to re-enable core dumps that were possibly disabled by file size
1054 limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations (ulimit -c), or "dumpability"
1055 of a process after changing its UID/GID (such as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable
1056 on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by the current directory's
1057 permissions (check what directory the file is started from), the chroot
1058 directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily disable the chroot
1059 directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location), or any other
1060 system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are notorious
1061 for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable not even
1062 installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often, simply
1063 writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the issue.
1064 When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to re-appear, it's
1065 often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by issuing, for example,
1066 "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it leaves a core where
1067 expected when dying.
1068
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001069ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1070 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1071 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001072 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001073 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001074 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1075 information and recommendations see e.g.
1076 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1077 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1078 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1079 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001080
1081ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1082 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1083 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1084 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1085 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1086 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001087 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1088 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1089 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001090 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001091
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001092ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1093 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1094 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1095 keyword to see available options.
1096
1097 Example:
1098 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001099 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001100
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001101ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1102 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1103 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001104 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001105 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001106 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1107 information and recommendations see e.g.
1108 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1109 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1110 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1111 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1112 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001113
1114ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1115 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1116 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1117 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1118 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1119 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001120 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1121 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1122 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1123 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001124
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001125ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1126 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1127 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1128 keyword to see available options.
1129
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001130ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1131 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1132 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1133 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001134 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001135 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001136 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1137 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1138 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1139 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001140 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1141 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1142 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1143
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001144ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1145 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1146 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1147 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1148
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001149stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1150 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1151 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1152 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001153 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001154 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001155
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001156 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1157 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1158 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001159
1160stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1161 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1162 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001163 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001164
1165stats maxconn <connections>
1166 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1167 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1168
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001169uid <number>
1170 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1171 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1172 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1173 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1174
1175ulimit-n <number>
1176 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1177 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1178 option.
1179
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001180unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1181 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1182
1183 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1184 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1185 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1186 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1187 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1188 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1189 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1190 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1191 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1192 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1193
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001194unsetenv [<name> ...]
1195 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1196 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1197 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1198 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1199 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1200 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1201 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1202
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001203user <user name>
1204 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1205 See also "uid" and "group".
1206
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001207node <name>
1208 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1209
1210 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1211 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1212 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1213 traffic.
1214
1215description <text>
1216 Add a text that describes the instance.
1217
1218 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1219 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1220 "<" and ">" characters.
1221
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100122251degrees-data-file <file path>
1223 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001224 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001225
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001226 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001227 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1228
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000122951degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001230 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1231 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1232 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1233
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001234 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001235 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1236
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200123751degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001238 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1239 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1240
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001241 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1242 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1243
124451degrees-cache-size <number>
1245 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1246 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1247 By default, this cache is disabled.
1248
1249 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001250 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1251
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001252wurfl-data-file <file path>
1253 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1254 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1255
1256 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1257 with USE_WURFL=1.
1258
1259wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1260 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1261 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1262 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1263
1264 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1265
1266 Valid WURFL properties are:
1267 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1268
1269 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1270 device.
1271
1272 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1273 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1274
1275 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1276 particular web request.
1277
1278 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1279 used Libwurfl API version.
1280
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001281 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1282 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1283
1284 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1285 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1286
1287 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1288
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001289 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1290 with USE_WURFL=1.
1291
1292wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1293 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1294 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1295
1296 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1297 with USE_WURFL=1.
1298
1299wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1300 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1301 thus before the chroot.
1302
1303 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1304 with USE_WURFL=1.
1305
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001306wurfl-cache-size <size>
1307 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1308 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001309 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001310 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001311
1312 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1313 with USE_WURFL=1.
1314
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013153.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001316-----------------------
1317
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001318busy-polling
1319 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1320 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1321 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1322 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1323 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1324 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1325 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1326 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1327 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1328 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1329 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1330 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1331 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1332 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1333 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1334 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1335 "poll" pollers.
1336
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001337max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1338 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1339 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1340 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1341 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1342 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1343 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1344 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1345 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1346
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001347maxconn <number>
1348 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1349 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1350 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001351 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1352 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1353 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1354 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001355 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1356 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1357 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1358 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1359 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1360 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001361
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001362maxconnrate <number>
1363 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1364 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1365 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1366 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1367 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1368 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1369 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1370 fairness.
1371
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001372maxcomprate <number>
1373 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001374 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001375 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1376 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1377 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001378 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001379 default value.
1380
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001381maxcompcpuusage <number>
1382 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1383 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1384 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1385 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1386 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1387 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1388 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1389 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1390
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001391maxpipes <number>
1392 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1393 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1394 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1395 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1396 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1397 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1398
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001399maxsessrate <number>
1400 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1401 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1402 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1403 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1404 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1405 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1406 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1407 fairness.
1408
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001409maxsslconn <number>
1410 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1411 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1412 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1413 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1414 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1415 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1416 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001417 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1418 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1419 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1420 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1421 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1422 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1423 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001424
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001425maxsslrate <number>
1426 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1427 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1428 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1429 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1430 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1431 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1432 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1433 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1434 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1435 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1436
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001437maxzlibmem <number>
1438 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1439 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1440 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001441 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1442 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1443 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1444
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001445noepoll
1446 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1447 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001448 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001449
1450nokqueue
1451 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1452 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1453 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1454
1455nopoll
1456 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1457 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001458 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001459 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001460
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001461nosplice
1462 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001463 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001464 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001465 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001466 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1467 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1468 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1469 "option splice-response".
1470
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001471nogetaddrinfo
1472 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1473 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1474
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001475noreuseport
1476 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1477 command line argument "-dR".
1478
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001479profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
1480 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
1481 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
1482 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
1483 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
1484 reutnrs below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
1485 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
1486 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
1487 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
1488 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
1489
1490 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
1491 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
1492 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
1493 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
1494 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001495 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1496 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1497 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1498 CLI.
1499
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001500spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001501 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1502 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1503 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1504 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1505 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1506 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001507
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001508ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001509 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001510 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001511 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1512 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1513 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1514 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1515 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001516 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1517 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001518 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1519 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1520 openssl configuration file uses:
1521 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1522
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001523ssl-mode-async
1524 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001525 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001526 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1527 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1528 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
1529 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and reneg
1530 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001531
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001532tune.buffers.limit <number>
1533 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1534 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1535 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1536 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1537 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001538 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001539 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1540 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1541 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1542 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1543 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1544 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1545 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1546 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1547 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1548
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001549tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1550 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1551 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1552 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1553 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1554
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001555tune.bufsize <number>
1556 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1557 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1558 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1559 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1560 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1561 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1562 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001563 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1564 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1565 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001566 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001567 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1568 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1569 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001570
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001571tune.chksize <number>
1572 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1573 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1574 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1575 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1576 checks whenever possible.
1577
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001578tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1579 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1580 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1581 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1582 this value. The default value is 1.
1583
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01001584tune.fail-alloc
1585 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
1586 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
1587 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
1588 gracefully.
1589
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001590tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1591 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1592 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1593 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1594 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1595 change it.
1596
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001597tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1598 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001599 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1600 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001601 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1602 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1603 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1604 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1605 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1606
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001607tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1608 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1609 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1610 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1611 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1612 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1613 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1614 recommended not to change this value.
1615
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01001616tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
1617 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
1618 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
1619 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
1620 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
1621 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
1622 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
1623 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
1624
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001625tune.http.cookielen <number>
1626 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1627 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1628 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1629 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1630 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1631 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1632 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1633 to change this value.
1634
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001635tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001636 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1637 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001638 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001639 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001640 configuration directives too.
1641 The default value is 1024.
1642
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001643tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1644 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1645 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1646 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1647 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1648 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1649 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001650 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1651 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1652 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001653
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001654tune.idletimer <timeout>
1655 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1656 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1657 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1658 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1659 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1660 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001661 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001662 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
1663 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1664
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01001665tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
1666 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
1667 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
1668 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
1669 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
1670 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
1671 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
1672 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
1673 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
1674 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
1675
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001676tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1677 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001678 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001679 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1680 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001681 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001682 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1683 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1684
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001685tune.lua.maxmem
1686 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1687 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1688 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1689 memory.
1690
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001691tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1692 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001693 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1694 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001695 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001696
1697tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1698 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1699 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1700 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1701 check servers.
1702
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001703tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1704 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1705 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1706 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001707 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001708
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001709tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001710 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1711 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1712 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1713 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1714 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1715 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1716 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1717 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1718 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1719 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001720
1721tune.maxpollevents <number>
1722 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1723 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1724 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1725 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1726 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1727
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001728tune.maxrewrite <number>
1729 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1730 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1731 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1732 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1733 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1734 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1735 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1736 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1737 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1738 bufsize.
1739
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001740tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1741 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1742 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1743 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1744 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1745 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1746 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1747 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1748 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1749 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
1750 about 5 MB on 32-bit systems and 8 MB on 64-bit systems. There is a very low
1751 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1752 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1753 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1754 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1755 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1756 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1757 setting this parameter to 0.
1758
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001759tune.pipesize <number>
1760 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1761 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1762 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1763 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1764 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1765 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1766
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02001767tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
1768 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
1769 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
1770 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
1771 default is 20.
1772
1773tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
1774 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
1775 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
1776 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
1777 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
1778 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
1779 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
1780 much sense in the general case when targetting connection reuse).
1781
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001782tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1783tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1784 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1785 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1786 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1787 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001788 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001789 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1790 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1791
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001792tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001793 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001794 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1795 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1796 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1797 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1798
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001799tune.runqueue-depth <number>
1800 Sets the maxinum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
1801 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
1802 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead.
1803
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001804tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1805tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1806 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1807 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1808 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1809 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001810 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001811 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1812 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1813 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1814 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1815 notifying haproxy again.
1816
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001817tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001818 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1819 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1820 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001821 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001822 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001823 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001824 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1825 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1826 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001827 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1828 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001829
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001830tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02001831 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001832 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1833 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1834 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1835 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1836 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1837
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001838tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1839 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001840 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001841 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1842 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1843 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1844 being used for too long.
1845
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001846tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1847 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1848 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1849 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1850 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1851 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1852 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1853 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1854 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1855 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1856 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001857 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001858 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001859
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001860tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1861 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1862 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1863 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1864 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1865 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1866 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1867 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001868 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1869 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001870
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001871tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1872 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1873 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1874 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1875 1000 entries.
1876
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001877tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
1878 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
1879 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
1880 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
1881
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001882tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001883tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001884tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1885tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1886tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001887 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
1888 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
1889 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
1890 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
1891 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
1892 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
1893 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
1894 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001895
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001896 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
1897 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
1898 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1899 all available space is consumed.
1900 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
1901 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
1902 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001903
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001904tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1905 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001906 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001907 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001908 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001909 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1910
1911tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1912 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1913 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001914 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1915 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001916
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019173.3. Debugging
1918--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001919
1920debug
1921 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1922 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1923 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1924 system startup.
1925
1926quiet
1927 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1928 line argument "-q".
1929
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001930
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010019313.4. Userlists
1932--------------
1933It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1934http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1935it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1936
1937userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001938 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001939 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1940
1941group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001942 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001943 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1944 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1945
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001946user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1947 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001948 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1949 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01001950 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
1951 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
1952 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
1953 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001954
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01001955 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
1956 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
1957 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
1958 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
1959 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
1960 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
1961 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
1962 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
1963 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001964
1965 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001966 userlist L1
1967 group G1 users tiger,scott
1968 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001969
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001970 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1971 user scott insecure-password elgato
1972 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001973
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001974 userlist L2
1975 group G1
1976 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001977
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001978 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1979 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1980 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001981
1982 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001983
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001984
19853.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001986----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02001987It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
1988several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
1989instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
1990values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
1991automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
1992In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
1993using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
1994tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
1995reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
1996Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
1997that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
1998each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001999
2000peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002001 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002002 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2003
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002004bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2005 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2006 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2007
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002008disabled
2009 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2010 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2011 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2012
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002013default-bind [param*]
2014 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2015
2016default-server [param*]
2017 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2018
2019 Arguments:
2020 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2021 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2022 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2023 details.
2024
2025
2026 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2027
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002028enable
2029 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2030
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002031peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002032 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2033 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
2034 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
2035 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
2036 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
2037 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
2038
2039 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2040 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2041
2042 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
2043 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
2044 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
2045 across all peers.
2046
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002047 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2048 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002049
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002050 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2051 "server" keyword explanation below).
2052
2053server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
2054 As previously mentionned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
2055 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2056 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2057 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2058 of this "peers" section).
2059 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2060
2061
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002062 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002063 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002064 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002065 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2066 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2067 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002068
2069 backend mybackend
2070 mode tcp
2071 balance roundrobin
2072 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2073 stick on src
2074
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002075 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2076 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002077
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002078 Example:
2079 peers mypeers
2080 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2081 default-server ssl verify none
2082 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2083 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002084
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002085
2086table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2087 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2088
2089 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2090 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
2091 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an aditionnal
2092 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2093 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2094 "stick-table" keyword).
2095
2096 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2097 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2098 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2099 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2100 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2101 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2102 of the stick-table name as follows:
2103
2104 peers mypeers
2105 peer A ...
2106 peer B ...
2107 table t1 ...
2108
2109 frontend fe1
2110 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2111
2112 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2113 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2114
2115 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2116 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2117 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2118 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2119 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2120 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2121 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2122
2123 peers mypeers
2124 peer A ...
2125 peer B ...
2126 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2127
2128 backend t1
2129 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2130
2131 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
2132 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2133 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2134
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090021353.6. Mailers
2136------------
2137It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2138If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2139in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2140
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002141mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002142 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2143 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2144
2145mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2146 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2147
2148 Example:
2149 mailers mymailers
2150 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2151 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2152
2153 backend mybackend
2154 mode tcp
2155 balance roundrobin
2156
2157 email-alert mailers mymailers
2158 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2159 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2160
2161 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2162 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2163
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002164timeout mail <time>
2165 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2166 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2167 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2168 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2169
2170 Example:
2171 mailers mymailers
2172 timeout mail 20s
2173 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002174
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021754. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002176----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002177
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002178Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002179 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002180 - frontend <name>
2181 - backend <name>
2182 - listen <name>
2183
2184A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2185its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2186section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002187section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002188
2189A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2190connections.
2191
2192A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2193to forward incoming connections.
2194
2195A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2196parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2197
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002198All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2199'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2200case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2201
2202Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2203logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2204proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2205However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2206name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2207
2208Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2209and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002210bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002211protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2212modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2213arbitrary criteria.
2214
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002215In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2216a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002217the backend's. HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002218
2219 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2220 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2221 between responses and new requests.
2222
2223 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
2224 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
2225 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01002226 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
2227 And because it cannot work in HTTP/2, this option is deprecated and it is
2228 only supported on legacy HTTP frontends. In HTX, it is ignored and a
2229 warning is emitted during HAProxy startup.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002230
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002231 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2232 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2233 client-facing connection remains open.
2234
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002235 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2236 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002237
2238The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2239frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2240following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002241weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002242
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002243 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002244
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002245 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2246 ----+-----+-----+----
2247 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2248 ----+-----+-----+----
2249 TUN | TUN | SCL | CLO
2250 Frontend ----+-----+-----+----
2251 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2252 ----+-----+-----+----
2253 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002254
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002255
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002256
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022574.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2258--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002259
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002260The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2261limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2262they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2263limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002264marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002265option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002266and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2267with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2268specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002269
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002270
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002271 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2272------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2273acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002274backlog X X X -
2275balance X - X X
2276bind - X X -
2277bind-process X X X X
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002278block (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002279capture cookie - X X -
2280capture request header - X X -
2281capture response header - X X -
2282clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002283compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002284contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2285cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002286declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002287default-server X - X X
2288default_backend X X X -
2289description - X X X
2290disabled X X X X
2291dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002292email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002293email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002294email-alert mailers X X X X
2295email-alert myhostname X X X X
2296email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002297enabled X X X X
2298errorfile X X X X
2299errorloc X X X X
2300errorloc302 X X X X
2301-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2302errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002303force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002304filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002305fullconn X - X X
2306grace X X X X
2307hash-type X - X X
2308http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002309http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002310http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002311http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002312http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002313http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002314http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002315id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002316ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002317load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002318log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002319log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002320log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002321log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002322max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002323maxconn X X X -
2324mode X X X X
2325monitor fail - X X -
2326monitor-net X X X -
2327monitor-uri X X X -
2328option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2329option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2330option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2331option allbackups (*) X - X X
2332option checkcache (*) X - X X
2333option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2334option contstats (*) X X X -
2335option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2336option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Tim Duesterhus44864ac2019-05-06 01:19:53 +02002337option forceclose (deprecated) (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002338-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2339option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002340option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002341option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002342option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002343option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02002344option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002345option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01002346option http-tunnel (deprecated) (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002347option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02002348option http-use-htx (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002349option httpchk X - X X
2350option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01002351option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002352option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002353option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002354option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002355option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002356option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2357option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2358option logasap (*) X X X -
2359option mysql-check X - X X
2360option nolinger (*) X X X X
2361option originalto X X X X
2362option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002363option pgsql-check X - X X
2364option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002365option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002366option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002367option smtpchk X - X X
2368option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2369option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2370option splice-request (*) X X X X
2371option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002372option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002373option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2374option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2375-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002376option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002377option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2378option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2379option tcpka X X X X
2380option tcplog X X X X
2381option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002382external-check command X - X X
2383external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002384persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2385rate-limit sessions X X X -
2386redirect - X X X
2387redisp (deprecated) X - X X
2388redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
2389reqadd - X X X
2390reqallow - X X X
2391reqdel - X X X
2392reqdeny - X X X
2393reqiallow - X X X
2394reqidel - X X X
2395reqideny - X X X
2396reqipass - X X X
2397reqirep - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002398reqitarpit - X X X
2399reqpass - X X X
2400reqrep - X X X
2401-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002402reqtarpit - X X X
2403retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02002404retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002405rspadd - X X X
2406rspdel - X X X
2407rspdeny - X X X
2408rspidel - X X X
2409rspideny - X X X
2410rspirep - X X X
2411rsprep - X X X
2412server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002413server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002414server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002415source X - X X
2416srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002417stats admin - X X X
2418stats auth X X X X
2419stats enable X X X X
2420stats hide-version X X X X
2421stats http-request - X X X
2422stats realm X X X X
2423stats refresh X X X X
2424stats scope X X X X
2425stats show-desc X X X X
2426stats show-legends X X X X
2427stats show-node X X X X
2428stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002429-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2430stick match - - X X
2431stick on - - X X
2432stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002433stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002434stick-table - X X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02002435tcp-check connect - - X X
2436tcp-check expect - - X X
2437tcp-check send - - X X
2438tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002439tcp-request connection - X X -
2440tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002441tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002442tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002443tcp-response content - - X X
2444tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002445timeout check X - X X
2446timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002447timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002448timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
2449timeout connect X - X X
2450timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2451timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2452timeout http-request X X X X
2453timeout queue X - X X
2454timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002455timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002456timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2457timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002458timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002459transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002460unique-id-format X X X -
2461unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002462use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002463use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002464------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2465 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002466
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002467
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020024684.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2469---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002470
2471This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2472
2473
2474acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2475 Declare or complete an access list.
2476 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2477 no | yes | yes | yes
2478 Example:
2479 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2480 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2481 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2482
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002483 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002484
2485
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002486backlog <conns>
2487 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2488 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2489 yes | yes | yes | no
2490 Arguments :
2491 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2492 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002493 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002494
2495 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2496 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2497 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2498 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2499 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2500 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2501 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2502 backlog parameter.
2503
2504 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2505 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2506 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2507
2508 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2509
2510
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002511balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002512balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002513 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2514 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2515 yes | no | yes | yes
2516 Arguments :
2517 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2518 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2519 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2520 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2521
2522 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2523 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2524 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2525 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002526 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002527 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002528 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2529 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2530 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2531 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2532 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2533 it, so that you don't worry.
2534
2535 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2536 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2537 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2538 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2539 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2540 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2541 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2542 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002543
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002544 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2545 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2546 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2547 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2548 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2549 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2550 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2551 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2552
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002553 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002554 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002555 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2556 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002557 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002558 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2559 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2560 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2561 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2562 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002563 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2564 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2565 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2566 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2567 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2568 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002569
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002570 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2571 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2572 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2573 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2574 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2575 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2576 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2577 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002578 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002579 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002580 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2581 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2582 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002583
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002584 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2585 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2586 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2587 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2588 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2589 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2590 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2591 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2592 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2593 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2594 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2595 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002596
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002597 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002598 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2599 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2600 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2601 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2602 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2603 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2604 URIs start with a leading "/".
2605
2606 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2607 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2608 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2609 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2610
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002611 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002612 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2613
2614 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002615 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2616 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002617 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2618 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2619 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2620 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002621 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002622 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2623 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002624
2625 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2626 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2627 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2628 server will receive the request.
2629
2630 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2631 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2632 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2633 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2634 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002635 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2636 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2637 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002638
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002639 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2640 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2641 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2642 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2643 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002644
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002645 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002646 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2647 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2648 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2649
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002650 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2651 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2652 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2653
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002654 random
2655 random(<draws>)
2656 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002657 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
2658 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
2659 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
2660 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002661 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
2662 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
2663 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
2664 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
2665 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
2666 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
2667 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
2668 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
2669 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
2670 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
2671 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
2672 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
2673 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
2674 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
2675 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
2676 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
2677 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
2678 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
2679 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
2680 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002681
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002682 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002683 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002684 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2685 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2686 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2687 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2688 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2689 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002690 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002691 used instead.
2692
2693 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2694 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2695 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2696 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2697
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002698 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2699 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2700 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2701
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002702 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002703
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002704 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002705 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2706 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002707
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002708 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2709 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2710 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002711
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002712 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
2713 based alghoritms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
2714 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
2715 NTLM relies on.
2716
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002717 Examples :
2718 balance roundrobin
2719 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002720 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002721 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2722 balance hdr(host)
2723 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002724
2725 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2726 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2727
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002728 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002729 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2730 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2731 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2732 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2733
2734 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2735 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2736 defaults to 16 kB.
2737
2738 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2739 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2740
2741 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2742 Round Robin.
2743
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00002744 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002745 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2746 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2747 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2748
2749 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2750
2751 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002752 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002753 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2754 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2755 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002756
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002757 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002758
2759
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002760bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2761bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002762 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2763 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2764 no | yes | yes | no
2765 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002766 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2767 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2768 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2769 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002770 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002771 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2772 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2773 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2774 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2775 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2776 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2777 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002778 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2779 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2780 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2781 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2782 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2783 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2784 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002785 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2786 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2787 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02002788 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
2789 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
2790 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
2791 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002792 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2793 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2794 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002795
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002796 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2797 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002798 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2799 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2800 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002801 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2802 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2803 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2804 the range.
2805
2806 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2807 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2808 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2809 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2810 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2811 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2812 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002813 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002814 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002815
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002816 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002817 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002818 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2819 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2820 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2821 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2822 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2823 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2824
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002825 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2826 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2827 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2828 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002829
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002830 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2831 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2832 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2833 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2834 in a frontend.
2835
2836 Example :
2837 listen http_proxy
2838 bind :80,:443
2839 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002840 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002841
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002842 listen http_https_proxy
2843 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002844 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002845
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002846 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2847 bind ipv6@:80
2848 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2849 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2850
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002851 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002852 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002853
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02002854 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
2855 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
2856 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
2857 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
2858 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
2859
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002860 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002861 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002862
2863
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002864bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002865 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2866 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2867 yes | yes | yes | yes
2868 Arguments :
2869 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2870 may be used to override a default value.
2871
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002872 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002873 option may be combined with other numbers.
2874
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002875 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002876 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2877 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2878 missing from all processes.
2879
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002880 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002881 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002882 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
2883 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
2884 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
2885 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
2886 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002887 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002888
2889 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2890 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2891 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2892 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2893 and 'even' instances.
2894
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002895 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2896 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2897 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
2898 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002899
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002900 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
2901 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
2902
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02002903 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
2904 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
2905 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
2906
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002907 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
2908 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
2909
2910 Example :
2911 listen app_ip1
2912 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002913 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002914
2915 listen app_ip2
2916 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002917 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002918
2919 listen management
2920 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002921 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002922
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002923 listen management
2924 bind 10.0.0.4:80
2925 bind-process 1-4
2926
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002927 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002928
2929
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002930block { if | unless } <condition> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002931 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
2932 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2933 no | yes | yes | yes
2934
2935 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
2936 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002937 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002938 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002939 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03002940 "block" statements per instance. To block connections at layer 4 (without
2941 sending a 403 error) see "tcp-request connection reject" and
2942 "tcp-request content reject" rules.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002943
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002944 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
2945 "http-request deny" instead.
2946
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002947 Example:
2948 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2949 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2950 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +03002951 # block is deprecated. Use http-request deny instead:
2952 #block if invalid_src || local_dst
2953 http-request deny if invalid_src || local_dst
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002954
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03002955 See also : section 7 about ACL usage, "http-request deny",
2956 "http-response deny", "tcp-request connection reject" and
2957 "tcp-request content reject".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002958
2959capture cookie <name> len <length>
2960 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
2961 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2962 no | yes | yes | no
2963 Arguments :
2964 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
2965 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
2966 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
2967 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002968 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002969
2970 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
2971 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
2972 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
2973 right if it exceeds <length>.
2974
2975 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
2976 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
2977 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
2978 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
2979
2980 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2981 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2982 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2983
2984 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2985 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2986 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002987 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2988 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2989 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002990
2991 Example:
2992 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2993
2994 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002995 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002996
2997
2998capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002999 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003000 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3001 no | yes | yes | no
3002 Arguments :
3003 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003004 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003005 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
3006 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3007 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3008
3009 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3010 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3011 it exceeds <length>.
3012
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003013 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003014 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
3015 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003016 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
3017 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
3018 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
3019 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003020 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003021 environments to find where the request came from.
3022
3023 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3024 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3025 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3026 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003027
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003028 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3029 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3030 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3031 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3032 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003033
3034 Example:
3035 capture request header Host len 15
3036 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003037 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003038
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003039 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003040 about logging.
3041
3042
3043capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003044 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003045 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3046 no | yes | yes | no
3047 Arguments :
3048 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003049 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003050 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3051 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3052 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3053
3054 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3055 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3056 it exceeds <length>.
3057
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003058 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003059 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3060 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3061 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003062 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3063 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3064 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3065 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003066
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003067 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3068 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3069 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3070 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3071 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003072
3073 Example:
3074 capture response header Content-length len 9
3075 capture response header Location len 15
3076
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003077 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003078 about logging.
3079
3080
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003081clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003082 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3083 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3084 yes | yes | yes | no
3085 Arguments :
3086 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
3087 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3088 as explained at the top of this document.
3089
3090 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
3091 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
3092 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
3093 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
3094 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
3095 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
3096 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
3097 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003098 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003099 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003100 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003101
3102 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
3103 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
3104 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
3105 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
3106 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
3107 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
3108
3109 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
3110 Please use "timeout client" instead.
3111
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01003112 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
3113 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003114
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003115compression algo <algorithm> ...
3116compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003117compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003118 Enable HTTP compression.
3119 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3120 yes | yes | yes | yes
3121 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003122 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3123 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3124 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3125
3126 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003127 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3128 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3129 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003130
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003131 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003132 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003133
3134 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3135 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3136 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3137 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3138 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003139 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003140
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003141 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3142 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3143 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3144 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3145 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3146 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3147 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003148 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003149
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003150 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003151 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003152 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3153 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3154 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3155 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3156 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003157
3158 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3159 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3160 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3161 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3162 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003163 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3164 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3165 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3166 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3167 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003168 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3169 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003170
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003171 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003172 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3173 "Accept-Encoding" header
3174 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003175 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003176 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3177 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3178 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3179 "multipart"
3180 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3181 header
3182 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3183 and later
3184 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3185 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003186 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003187
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01003188 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003189
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003190 Examples :
3191 compression algo gzip
3192 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003193
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003194
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003195contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003196 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3197 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3198 yes | no | yes | yes
3199 Arguments :
3200 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
3201 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3202 as explained at the top of this document.
3203
3204 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003205 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003206 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003207 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003208 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
3209 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
3210 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
3211
3212 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
3213 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
3214 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
3215 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
3216 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
3217 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
3218
3219 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
3220 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
3221 instead.
3222
3223 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
3224 "timeout server", "contimeout".
3225
3226
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003227cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003228 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3229 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003230 [ dynamic ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003231 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3232 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3233 yes | no | yes | yes
3234 Arguments :
3235 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3236 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3237 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3238 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3239 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3240 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003241 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003242 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3243 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3244
3245 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3246 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3247 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3248 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3249 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3250 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003251 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3252 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003253 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003254 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3255 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003256
3257 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003258 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003259
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003260 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003261 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
3262 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003263 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003264 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3265 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3266 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3267 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3268 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3269 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3270 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003271
3272 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3273 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3274 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3275 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3276 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3277 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3278 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3279 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3280 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003281 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003282 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3283 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3284 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003285
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003286 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3287 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3288 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003289 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3290 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3291 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3292 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003293 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3294 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3295 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003296
3297 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3298 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3299 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3300 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3301 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3302 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3303 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3304 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3305 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3306
3307 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3308 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3309 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3310 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3311 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3312 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3313 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3314 persistence cookie in the cache.
3315 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3316
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003317 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3318 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3319 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3320 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3321 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003322 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003323 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3324 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3325 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3326 they logout.
3327
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003328 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3329 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3330 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3331 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3332
3333 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3334 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3335 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3336 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3337 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3338 this attribute.
3339
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003340 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003341 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003342 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3343 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3344 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3345 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3346 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3347 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003348
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003349 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3350 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3351 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3352 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3353 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3354 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3355 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3356 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003357 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003358 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3359 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3360 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3361 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3362 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3363 the site.
3364
3365 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3366 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3367 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3368 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3369 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3370 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3371 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3372 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3373 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3374 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3375 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3376 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3377 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003378 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003379 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3380 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3381
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003382 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3383 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3384 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3385 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3386 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3387 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3388
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003389 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3390 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3391 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3392 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003393
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003394 Examples :
3395 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3396 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3397 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003398 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003399
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003400 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003401
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003402
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003403declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3404 Declares a capture slot.
3405 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3406 no | yes | yes | no
3407 Arguments:
3408 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3409
3410 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3411 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3412 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3413 for use in the response.
3414
3415 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003416 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003417 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3418
3419
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003420default-server [param*]
3421 Change default options for a server in a backend
3422 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3423 yes | no | yes | yes
3424 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003425 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3426 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3427 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3428 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003429
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003430 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003431 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3432
3433 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003434
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003435
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003436default_backend <backend>
3437 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3438 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3439 yes | yes | yes | no
3440 Arguments :
3441 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3442
3443 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3444 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3445 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3446 will catch all undetermined requests.
3447
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003448 Example :
3449
3450 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3451 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3452 default_backend dynamic
3453
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003454 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003455
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003456
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003457description <string>
3458 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3459 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3460 no | yes | yes | yes
3461 Arguments : string
3462
3463 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3464 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3465 it describes.
3466 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3467
3468
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003469disabled
3470 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3471 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3472 yes | yes | yes | yes
3473 Arguments : none
3474
3475 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3476 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3477 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3478 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3479 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3480 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3481 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3482
3483 See also : "enabled"
3484
3485
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003486dispatch <address>:<port>
3487 Set a default server address
3488 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3489 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003490 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003491
3492 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3493 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3494 during start-up.
3495
3496 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3497 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3498 possible with normal servers.
3499
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003500 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003501 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3502 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3503 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3504 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3505
3506 See also : "server"
3507
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003508
3509dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3510 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3511 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3512 yes | no | yes | yes
3513 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3514
3515 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003516 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003517 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3518 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003519 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003520 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003521
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003522enabled
3523 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3524 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3525 yes | yes | yes | yes
3526 Arguments : none
3527
3528 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3529 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3530
3531 See also : "disabled"
3532
3533
3534errorfile <code> <file>
3535 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3536 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3537 yes | yes | yes | yes
3538 Arguments :
3539 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003540 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3541 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003542
3543 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003544 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003545 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003546 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3547 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003548
3549 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3550 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3551 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3552
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003553 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3554
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003555 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3556 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3557 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3558 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3559
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003560 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3561 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003562 not to put any reference to local contents (e.g. images) in order to avoid
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003563 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3564 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3565 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3566
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003567 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3568 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3569 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003570 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003571 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3572
3573 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3574
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003575 Example :
3576 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003577 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003578 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3579 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3580
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003581
3582errorloc <code> <url>
3583errorloc302 <code> <url>
3584 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3585 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3586 yes | yes | yes | yes
3587 Arguments :
3588 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003589 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3590 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003591
3592 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3593 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3594 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3595 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003596 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003597
3598 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3599 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3600 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3601
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003602 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3603
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003604 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3605 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3606 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3607 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003608 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003609 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3610 request.
3611
3612 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3613
3614
3615errorloc303 <code> <url>
3616 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3617 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3618 yes | yes | yes | yes
3619 Arguments :
3620 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003621 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3622 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003623
3624 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3625 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3626 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3627 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003628 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003629
3630 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3631 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3632 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3633
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003634 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3635
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003636 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3637 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3638 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3639 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003640 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003641
3642 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3643
3644
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003645email-alert from <emailaddr>
3646 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003647 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003648 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3649 yes | yes | yes | yes
3650
3651 Arguments :
3652
3653 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3654
3655 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3656 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3657
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003658 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003659 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3660 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003661
3662
3663email-alert level <level>
3664 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3665 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3666 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3667 yes | yes | yes | yes
3668
3669 Arguments :
3670
3671 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3672 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3673 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3674
3675 By default level is alert
3676
3677 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3678 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3679 for the proxy.
3680
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003681 Alerts are sent when :
3682
3683 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3684 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3685 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3686 is notice or lower
3687 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3688 and a health check status update occurs
3689
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003690 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3691 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003692 section 3.6 about mailers.
3693
3694
3695email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3696 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3697 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3698 yes | yes | yes | yes
3699
3700 Arguments :
3701
3702 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3703
3704 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3705 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3706
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003707 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3708 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003709
3710
3711email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3712 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3713 mailers.
3714 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3715 yes | yes | yes | yes
3716
3717 Arguments :
3718
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003719 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003720
3721 By default the systems hostname is used.
3722
3723 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3724 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3725 for the proxy.
3726
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003727 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3728 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003729
3730
3731email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003732 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003733 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3734 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3735 yes | yes | yes | yes
3736
3737 Arguments :
3738
3739 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3740
3741 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3742 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3743
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003744 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003745 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3746
3747
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003748force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3749 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3750 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003751 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003752
3753 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3754 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3755 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3756 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3757 marked down for maintenance operations.
3758
3759 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3760 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3761 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3762 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3763 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3764 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3765 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3766 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3767 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3768
3769 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3770 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3771 is used.
3772
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003773 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003774 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003775
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003776
3777filter <name> [param*]
3778 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3779 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3780 no | yes | yes | yes
3781 Arguments :
3782 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3783 referenced in section 9.
3784
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003785 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003786 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003787 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
3788 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003789
3790 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3791 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3792
3793 Example:
3794 listen
3795 bind *:80
3796
3797 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3798 filter compression
3799 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3800
3801 compression algo gzip
3802 compression offload
3803
3804 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3805
3806 See also : section 9.
3807
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003808
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003809fullconn <conns>
3810 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3811 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3812 yes | no | yes | yes
3813 Arguments :
3814 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3815 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3816
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003817 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003818 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003819 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003820 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3821 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3822 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3823 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3824 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003825 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003826
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003827 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3828 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003829 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3830 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3831 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003832
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003833 Example :
3834 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3835 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3836 # connections.
3837 backend dynamic
3838 fullconn 10000
3839 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3840 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3841
3842 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3843
3844
3845grace <time>
3846 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3847 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003848 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003849 Arguments :
3850 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3851 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3852 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3853
3854 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3855 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003856 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003857 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3858
3859 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3860 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3861 simplify it.
3862
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003863
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003864hash-balance-factor <factor>
3865 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
3866 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3867 yes | no | no | yes
3868 Arguments :
3869 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
3870 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01003871 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003872
3873 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
3874 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
3875 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
3876 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
3877 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
3878 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
3879 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
3880
3881 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
3882 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
3883 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
3884 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
3885 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
3886
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003887 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
3888 consistent hashing mechanism.
3889
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003890 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
3891
3892
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003893hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003894 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3895 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3896 yes | no | yes | yes
3897 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003898 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3899 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003900
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003901 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3902 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3903 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3904 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3905 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3906 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3907 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3908 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3909 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3910 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003911
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003912 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3913 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3914 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3915 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3916 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3917 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3918 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3919 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3920 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3921 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3922 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3923 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3924 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003925 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3926 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003927
3928 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3929
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003930 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003931 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
3932 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
3933 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003934 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
3935 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
3936 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003937
3938 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
3939 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003940 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
3941 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
3942 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
3943 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
3944
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01003945 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
3946 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
3947 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
3948 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
3949 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
3950 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
3951 parameter.
3952
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01003953 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
3954 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
3955 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
3956 used on strings.
3957
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003958 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
3959
3960 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
3961 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
3962 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
3963 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
3964 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
3965 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
3966 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
3967 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
3968 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
3969 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
3970 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
3971 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003972
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003973 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
3974 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
3975 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003976
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003977 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003978
3979
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003980http-check disable-on-404
3981 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
3982 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003983 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003984 Arguments : none
3985
3986 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
3987 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
3988 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
3989 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
3990 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
3991 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
3992 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
3993 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003994 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
3995 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
3996 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
3997
3998 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
3999
4000
4001http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004002 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004003 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02004004 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004005 Arguments :
4006 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
4007 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004008 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004009 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
4010 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
4011 details on the supported keywords.
4012
4013 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
4014 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
4015 with the usual backslash ('\').
4016
4017 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
4018 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
4019 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
4020 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
4021 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
4022
4023 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004024 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004025 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
4026 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4027 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4028
4029 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004030 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004031 response's status code matches the expression. If the
4032 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4033 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4034 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
4035
4036 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004037 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004038 response's body contains this exact string. If the
4039 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4040 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
4041 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
4042 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004043 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004044 trace).
4045
4046 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004047 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004048 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
4049 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4050 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
4051 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
4052 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004053 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004054
4055 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
4056 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
4057 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
4058 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
4059 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
4060 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
4061 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
4062 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
4063
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01004064 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
4065 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
4066 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
4067
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004068 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
4069 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
4070
4071 Examples :
4072 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004073 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004074
4075 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004076 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004077
4078 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004079 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004080
4081 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004082 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004083
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004084 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004085
4086
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004087http-check send-state
4088 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
4089 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4090 yes | no | yes | yes
4091 Arguments : none
4092
4093 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
4094 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
4095 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
4096 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
4097 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
4098
4099 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
4100 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
4101 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
4102 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
4103 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08004104 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
4105 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
4106 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4107
4108 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
4109 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
4110 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4111
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004112 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
4113 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
4114 checked in multiple backends.
4115
4116 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
4117 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
4118
4119 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
4120 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
4121 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
4122 one fails.
4123
4124 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
4125 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
4126 connections on all servers of the same backend.
4127
4128 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
4129 server's queue.
4130
4131 Example of a header received by the application server :
4132 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
4133 scur=13/22; qcur=0
4134
4135 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
4136
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004137
4138http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004139 Access control for Layer 7 requests
4140
4141 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4142 no | yes | yes | yes
4143
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004144 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4145 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4146 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4147 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4148 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004149
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004150 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4151 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004152
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004153 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004154
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004155 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
4156 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
4157 or "reqadd" rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are
4158 visible by almost all further ACL rules.
Willy Tarreau53275e82017-11-24 07:52:01 +01004159
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004160 Using "reqadd"/"reqdel"/"reqrep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4161 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4162 delete headers, you can still use "reqdel". Also please use
4163 "http-request deny/allow/tarpit" instead of "reqdeny"/"reqpass"/"reqtarpit".
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01004164
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004165 Example:
4166 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4167 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4168 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004169
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004170 http-request allow if nagios
4171 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4172 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4173 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01004174
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004175 Example:
4176 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4177 acl add path /addacl
4178 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004179
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004180 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004181
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004182 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4183 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004184
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004185 Example:
4186 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4187 acl setmap path /setmap
4188 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004189
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004190 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004191
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004192 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4193 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004194
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004195 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4196 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004197
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004198http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004199
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004200 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4201 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4202 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4203 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4204 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
4205 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4206 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4207 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004208
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004209http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004210
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004211 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
4212 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
4213 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
4214 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
4215 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
4216 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
4217 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
4218 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004219
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004220http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004221
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004222 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
4223 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004224
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004225
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004226http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004227
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004228 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
4229 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
4230 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
4231 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
4232 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004233
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004234 Example:
4235 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
4236 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004237
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004238http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004239
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004240 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004241
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004242http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
4243 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004244
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004245 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
4246 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
4247 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
4248 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
4249 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
4250 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
4251 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
4252 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
4253 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004254
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004255 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
4256 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
4257 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
4258 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword. If the slot
4259 <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration to prevent
4260 unexpected behavior at run time.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004261
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004262http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004263
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004264 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4265 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4266 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4267 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4268 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4269 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004270
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004271http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004272
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004273 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004274
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004275http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004276
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004277 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4278 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4279 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4280 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4281 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4282 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004283
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004284http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004285
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004286 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request
4287 and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
4288 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
4289 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive.
4290 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004291
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01004292http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
4293
4294 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
4295 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
4296 pointed by <resolvers>.
4297 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
4298 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
4299 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
4300 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
4301 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
4302 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
4303 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
4304 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
4305 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
4306 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
4307 to 0.0.0.0.
4308
4309 Example:
4310 resolvers mydns
4311 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
4312 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
4313 timeout retry 1s
4314 hold valid 10s
4315 hold nx 3s
4316 hold other 3s
4317 hold obsolete 0s
4318 accepted_payload_size 8192
4319
4320 frontend fe
4321 bind 10.42.0.1:80
4322 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
4323 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
4324
4325 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
4326 # which mean DNS resolution error
4327 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
4328
4329 default_backend be
4330
4331 backend b_503
4332 # dummy backend used to return 503.
4333 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
4334 # 503 error page to end users
4335
4336 backend be
4337 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
4338 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
4339 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
4340 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
4341 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
4342
4343 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
4344 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
4345
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004346http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4347
4348 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
4349 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
4350 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
4351 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01004352 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
4353 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004354
4355 See RFC 8297 for more information.
4356
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004357http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004358
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004359 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
4360 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
4361 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
4362 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
4363 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004364
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004365http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004366
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004367 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
4368 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
4369 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
4370 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004371
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004372http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4373 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02004374
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004375 This matches the regular expression in all occurrences of header field
4376 <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with the
4377 <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt and
4378 work like in <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header". The match is
4379 only case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
4380 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they may
4381 contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas in
4382 their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004383
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004384 Example:
4385 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004386
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004387 # applied to:
4388 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004389
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004390 # outputs:
4391 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004392
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004393 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004394
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004395http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4396 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004397
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004398 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4399 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
4400 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
4401 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004402
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004403 Example:
4404 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004405
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004406 # applied to:
4407 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004408
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004409 # outputs:
4410 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004411
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004412http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4413http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004414
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004415 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4416 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4417 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004418
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004419http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004420
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004421 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated by
4422 <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If an error
4423 occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004424
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004425http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004426
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004427 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4428 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
4429 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
4430 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
4431 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004432
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004433 Arguments:
4434 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4435 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004436
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004437 Example:
4438 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4439 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004440
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004441 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
4442 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004443
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004444http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004445
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004446 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4447 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
4448 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004449
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004450 Arguments:
4451 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4452 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004453
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004454 Example:
4455 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4456 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004457
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004458 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4459 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4460 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004461
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004462http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004463
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004464 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
4465 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4466 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4467 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
4468 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004469
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004470 Example:
4471 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4472 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
4473 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
4474 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4475 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4476 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4477 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4478 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4479 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004480
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004481http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004482
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004483 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
4484 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
4485 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
4486 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
4487 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004488
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004489http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
4490 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004491
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004492 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4493 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4494 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
4495 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
4496 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4497 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4498 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4499 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4500 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004501
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004502http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004503
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004504 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
4505 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
4506 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
4507 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
4508 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
4509 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
4510 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004511
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004512http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004513
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004514 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
4515 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
4516 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004517
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004518http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004519
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004520 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
4521 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
4522 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
4523 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
4524 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
4525 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
4526 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
4527 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004528
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004529http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004530
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004531 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
4532 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
4533 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
4534 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
4535 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
4536 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004537
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004538 Example :
4539 # prepend the host name before the path
4540 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004541
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004542http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02004543
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004544 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
4545 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
4546 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4547 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
4548 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004549
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004550http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004551
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004552 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
4553 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
4554 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4555 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
4556 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
4557 values have higher priority.
4558 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
4559 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
4560 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
4561 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
4562 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004563
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004564http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004565
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004566 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
4567 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
4568 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
4569 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
4570 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
4571 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
4572 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004573
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004574 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004575
4576 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004577 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
4578 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004579
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004580http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4581 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
4582 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
4583 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
4584 privacy.
4585
4586 Arguments :
4587 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4588 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004589
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004590 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004591 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
4592 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
4593
4594 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
4595 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
4596
4597http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4598
4599 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
4600 expression.
4601
4602 Arguments:
4603 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4604 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004605
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004606 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004607 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
4608 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
4609
4610 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
4611 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
4612 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
4613
4614http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4615
4616 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
4617 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
4618 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
4619 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
4620 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
4621 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
4622 information from the request.
4623
4624 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4625
4626http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4627
4628 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
4629 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
4630 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
4631 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
4632 path and the query string.
4633 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
4634
4635http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4636
4637 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4638 inline.
4639
4640 Arguments:
4641 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4642 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4643 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4644 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4645 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4646 (request and response)
4647 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4648 processing
4649 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4650 processing
4651 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4652 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
4653 and '_'.
4654
4655 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4656 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004657
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004658 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004659 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004660
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004661http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
4662 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004663
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004664 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
4665 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
4666 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
4667 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
4668 agent name must be used.
4669
4670 Arguments:
4671 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
4672
4673 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4674 configuration.
4675
4676http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4677
4678 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
4679 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
4680 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
4681 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
4682 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
4683 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
4684 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
4685 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
4686 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
4687 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
4688 action.
4689 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
4690 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
4691 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
4692 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
4693 you fully understand how it works.
4694
4695http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4696
4697 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
4698 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
4699 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
4700 is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status code
4701 specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the client
4702 does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT".
4703 The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when
4704 they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
4705 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load
4706 on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
4707 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the front
4708 firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
4709 See also the "silent-drop" action.
4710
4711http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4712http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4713http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4714
4715 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
4716 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
4717 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
4718 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
4719 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
4720 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4721 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
4722 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
4723 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4724 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
4725 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
4726 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
4727
4728 Arguments :
4729 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
4730 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
4731 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
4732 select which table entry to update the counters.
4733
4734 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
4735 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
4736 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
4737 that table until the session ends.
4738
4739 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
4740 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
4741 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
4742 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
4743 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
4744 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
4745 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
4746 useful information.
4747
4748 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
4749 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
4750 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
4751 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
4752 checks that make use of it.
4753
4754http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4755
4756 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004757
4758 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004759 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004760
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004761http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004762
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004763 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
4764 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
4765 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004766
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004767
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004768http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004769 Access control for Layer 7 responses
4770
4771 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4772 no | yes | yes | yes
4773
4774 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4775 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4776 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4777 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4778 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4779 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4780
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004781 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4782 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004783
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004784 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004785
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004786 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
4787 the HTTP processing, before "rspdel" or "rsprep" or "rspadd" rules. That way,
4788 headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further
4789 ACL rules.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004790
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004791 Using "rspadd"/"rspdel"/"rsprep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4792 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4793 delete headers, you can still use "rspdel". Also please use
4794 "http-response deny" instead of "rspdeny".
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004795
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004796 Example:
4797 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004798
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004799 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004800
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004801 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4802 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004803
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004804 Example:
4805 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004806
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004807 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004808
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004809 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
4810 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004811
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004812 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4813 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004814
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004815http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004816
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004817 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4818 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4819 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4820 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4821 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
4822 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4823 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4824 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004825
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004826http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004827
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004828 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
4829 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
4830 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
4831 example, or to pass some internal information.
4832 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4833 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4834 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004835
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004836http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004837
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004838 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
4839 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004840
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004841http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004842
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004843 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004844
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004845http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004846
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004847 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
4848 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
4849 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
4850 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
4851 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
4852 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
4853 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004854
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004855 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
4856 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
4857 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
4858 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
4859 keyword.
4860 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration
4861 to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004862
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004863http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004864
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004865 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4866 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4867 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4868 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4869 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4870 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004871
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004872http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004873
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004874 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004875
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004876http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004877
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004878 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4879 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4880 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4881 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4882 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4883 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004884
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004885http-response deny [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004886
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004887 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response
4888 and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004889
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004890http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004891
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004892 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
4893 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
4894 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
4895 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
4896 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
4897 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004898
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004899http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4900 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004901
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004902 This matches the regular expression in all occurrences of header field <name>
4903 according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with the <replace-fmt> argument.
4904 Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt and work like in <fmt> arguments
4905 in "add-header". The match is only case-sensitive. It is important to
4906 understand that this action only considers whole header lines, regardless of
4907 the number of values they may contain. This usage is suited to headers
4908 naturally containing commas in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and
4909 so on.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004910
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004911 Example:
4912 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004913
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004914 # applied to:
4915 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004916
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004917 # outputs:
4918 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004919
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004920 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004921
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004922http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4923 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004924
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004925 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4926 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the entire
4927 header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry more than
4928 one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004929
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004930 Example:
4931 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004932
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004933 # applied to:
4934 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004935
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004936 # outputs:
4937 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004938
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004939http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4940http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004941
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004942 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4943 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4944 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004945
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004946http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004947
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004948 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated by
4949 <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If an error
4950 occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004951
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004952http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004953
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004954 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
4955 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
4956 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
4957 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
4958 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004959
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004960 Arguments:
4961 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004962
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004963 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4964 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004965
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004966http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004967
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004968 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
4969 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
4970 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004971
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004972http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4973
4974 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
4975 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
4976 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
4977 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
4978 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
4979
4980http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
4981
4982 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4983 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4984 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
4985 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
4986 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
4987 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
4988 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4989 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
4990 be triggered by an HTTP response.
4991
4992http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4993
4994 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
4995 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
4996 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
4997 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
4998 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
4999 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
5000 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
5001
5002http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5003
5004 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
5005 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
5006 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
5007 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
5008 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
5009 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5010 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5011 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
5012
5013http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5014 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5015
5016 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5017 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5018 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5019 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005020
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005021 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005022 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5023 http-response set-status 431
5024 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5025 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005026
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005027http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005028
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005029 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5030 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
5031 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
5032 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
5033 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
5034 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
5035 based on some information from the request.
5036
5037 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5038
5039http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5040
5041 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5042 inline.
5043
5044 Arguments:
5045 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5046 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5047 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5048 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5049 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5050 (request and response)
5051 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5052 processing
5053 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5054 processing
5055 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5056 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5057 and '_'.
5058
5059 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5060 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005061
5062 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005063 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005064
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005065http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005066
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005067 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
5068 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
5069 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
5070 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
5071 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
5072 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
5073 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
5074 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
5075 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
5076 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
5077 action.
5078 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
5079 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
5080 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
5081 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
5082 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005083
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005084http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5085http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5086http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005087
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005088 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
5089 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
5090 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
5091 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
5092 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
5093 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
5094
5095http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5096
5097 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
5098 about <var-name>.
5099
5100 Example:
5101 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5102
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02005103
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005104http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
5105 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
5106
5107 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5108 yes | no | yes | yes
5109
5110 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005111 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
5112 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
5113 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005114
5115 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
5116
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005117 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
5118 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
5119 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
5120 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
5121 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
5122 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
5123 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
5124 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
5125 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
5126 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005127
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005128 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
5129 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
5130 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
5131 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
5132 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
5133 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
5134 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
5135 effects.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005136
5137 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
5138 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
5139 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
5140 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
5141 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
5142 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
5143 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
5144 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
5145 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweights the
5146 downsides of rare connection failures.
5147
5148 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
5149 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
5150 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
5151 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
5152 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
5153 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005154 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005155 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
5156 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
5157 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
5158 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
5159 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
5160
5161 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005162 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
5163 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
5164 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005165
5166 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005167 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005168
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02005169 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
5170 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005171
5172 No connection pool is involved, once a session dies, the last idle connection
5173 it was attached to is deleted at the same time. This ensures that connections
5174 may not last after all sessions are closed.
5175
5176 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
5177 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
5178 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
5179
5180 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
5181
5182
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005183http-send-name-header [<header>]
5184 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
5185
5186 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5187 yes | no | yes | yes
5188
5189 Arguments :
5190
5191 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
5192
5193 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005194 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005195 is added with the header string proved.
5196
5197 See also : "server"
5198
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005199id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02005200 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
5201 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5202 no | yes | yes | yes
5203 Arguments : none
5204
5205 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
5206 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
5207 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005208
5209
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005210ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5211 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
5212 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005213 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005214
5215 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
5216 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
5217 and running).
5218
5219 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5220 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
5221 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005222 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005223 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
5224
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005225 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5226 "unless" condition is met.
5227
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005228 Example:
5229 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
5230 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
5231 ignore-persist if url_static
5232
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005233 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
5234
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005235load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
5236 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
5237 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5238 yes | no | yes | yes
5239
5240 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
5241 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
5242 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005243 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005244 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
5245 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
5246 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
5247 over the stats socket and redirect output.
5248
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005249 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005250 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02005251 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005252
5253 Arguments:
5254 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
5255 named "server-state-file".
5256
5257 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
5258 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
5259 name is used as a file name.
5260
5261 none don't load any stat for this backend
5262
5263 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005264 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
5265 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
5266 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005267 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005268 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005269
5270 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
5271 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
5272
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005273 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005274
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005275 global
5276 stats socket /tmp/socket
5277 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005278
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005279 defaults
5280 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005281
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005282 backend bk
5283 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5284 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005285
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005286
5287 Then one can run :
5288
5289 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
5290
5291 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
5292
5293 1
5294 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5295 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5296 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5297
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005298 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005299
5300 global
5301 stats socket /tmp/socket
5302 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
5303
5304 defaults
5305 load-server-state-from-file local
5306
5307 backend bk
5308 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5309 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
5310
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005311
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005312 Then one can run :
5313
5314 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
5315
5316 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
5317
5318 1
5319 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5320 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5321 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5322
5323 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
5324 "show servers state"
5325
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005326
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005327log global
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02005328log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
5329 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005330no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005331 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
5332 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5333 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005334
5335 Prefix :
5336 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
5337 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
5338 prefix does not allow arguments.
5339
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005340 Arguments :
5341 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
5342 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
5343 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
5344 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
5345 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
5346 parameter.
5347
5348 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
5349 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
5350
5351 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
5352 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5353 standard syslog port).
5354
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01005355 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
5356 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5357 standard syslog port).
5358
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005359 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
5360 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
5361 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005362 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005363
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005364 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
5365 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
5366 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
5367 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
5368 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
5369 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
5370 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
5371 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
5372 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
5373 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
5374 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
5375 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
5376 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
5377 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
5378 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
5379 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005380 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
5381 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005382
5383 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
5384 and "fd@2", see above.
5385
5386 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
5387 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005388
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005389 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
5390 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
5391 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
5392 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
5393 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
5394 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
5395 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
5396 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
5397 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
5398 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005399 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005400
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02005401 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
5402 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
5403 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
5404 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
5405 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
5406
5407 <sample_size>
5408 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
5409 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
5410 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
5411 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
5412 (see also <ranges> parameter).
5413
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01005414 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
5415 one of the following :
5416
5417 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
5418 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
5419
5420 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
5421 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
5422
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005423 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
5424 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
5425 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
5426 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
5427 systemd logger consumes.
5428
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005429 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
5430 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
5431 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
5432 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
5433
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005434 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
5435
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005436 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
5437 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
5438 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
5439
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005440 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
5441 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
5442 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
5443 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005444
5445 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
5446 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
5447 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005448 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
5449 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
5450 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
5451 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
5452 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005453
5454 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
5455
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005456 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
5457 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
5458 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005459
5460 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
5461 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
5462 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
5463 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
5464
5465 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
5466 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005467
5468 Example :
5469 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005470 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
5471 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
5472 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005473 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
5474 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02005475 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005476
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005477
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005478log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005479 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
5480 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5481 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005482
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005483 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
5484 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
5485 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
5486 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
5487 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005488
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02005489 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
5490 "option httplog" directives.
5491
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02005492log-format-sd <string>
5493 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
5494 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5495 yes | yes | yes | no
5496
5497 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
5498 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
5499 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
5500 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
5501 which covers the log format string in depth.
5502
5503 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
5504 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
5505
5506 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
5507 log format to "rfc5424".
5508
5509 Example :
5510 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
5511
5512
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01005513log-tag <string>
5514 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
5515 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5516 yes | yes | yes | yes
5517
5518 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
5519 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
5520 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
5521 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
5522 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
5523 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
5524 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
5525 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
5526 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005527
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005528max-keep-alive-queue <value>
5529 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
5530 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5531 yes | no | yes | yes
5532
5533 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
5534 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
5535 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
5536 servers.
5537
5538 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
5539 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
5540 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
5541 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
5542 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005543 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005544 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
5545 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
5546 picking a different server.
5547
5548 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
5549 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
5550 even if they have to be queued.
5551
5552 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
5553 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
5554
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01005555max-session-srv-conns <nb>
5556 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
5557 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
5558 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005559
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005560maxconn <conns>
5561 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
5562 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5563 yes | yes | yes | no
5564 Arguments :
5565 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
5566 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
5567 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
5568 closes.
5569
5570 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
5571 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
5572 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
5573 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01005574 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
5575 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
5576 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
5577 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005578
5579 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
5580 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
5581 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
5582
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01005583 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
5584 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02005585
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005586 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
5587
5588
5589mode { tcp|http|health }
5590 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
5591 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5592 yes | yes | yes | yes
5593 Arguments :
5594 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
5595 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
5596 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
5597 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
5598
5599 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
5600 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
5601 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
5602 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
5603 brings HAProxy most of its value.
5604
5605 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005606 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
5607 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
5608 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
5609 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
5610 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
5611 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
5612 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005613
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005614 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
5615 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
5616 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005617
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005618 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005619 defaults http_instances
5620 mode http
5621
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005622 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005623
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005624
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005625monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005626 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005627 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5628 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005629 Arguments :
5630 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
5631 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005632 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005633 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
5634 backend and its backup.
5635
5636 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
5637 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
5638 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
5639 servers in a list of backends.
5640
5641 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
5642 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
5643 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
5644 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
5645 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
5646 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
5647 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005648 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
5649 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005650
5651 Example:
5652 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005653 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005654 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
5655 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
5656 monitor-uri /site_alive
5657 monitor fail if site_dead
5658
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005659 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005660
5661
5662monitor-net <source>
5663 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
5664 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5665 yes | yes | yes | no
5666 Arguments :
5667 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
5668 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
5669 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
5670 followed by a mask.
5671
5672 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
5673 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005674 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005675 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
5676
5677 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
5678 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
5679 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
5680 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005681 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
5682 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
5683 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005684
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005685 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
5686 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
5687 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
5688 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
5689 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
5690 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005691
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01005692 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
5693 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005694
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005695 Example :
5696 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
5697 frontend www
5698 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
5699
5700 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
5701
5702
5703monitor-uri <uri>
5704 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
5705 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5706 yes | yes | yes | no
5707 Arguments :
5708 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
5709 health status instead of forwarding the request.
5710
5711 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
5712 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
5713 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
5714 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
5715 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
5716 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
5717 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
5718 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
5719
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01005720 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
5721 and even before any "http-request" or "block" rulesets. The only rulesets
5722 applied before are the tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it
5723 is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an
5724 upper component, nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of
5725 conditions using "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted
5726 to whatever check can be imagined (most often the number of available servers
5727 in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005728
5729 Example :
5730 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
5731 frontend www
5732 mode http
5733 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
5734
5735 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
5736
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005737
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005738option abortonclose
5739no option abortonclose
5740 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
5741 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5742 yes | no | yes | yes
5743 Arguments : none
5744
5745 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
5746 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
5747 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
5748 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005749 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005750 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
5751 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
5752 encountered while delivering the response.
5753
5754 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
5755 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
5756 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
5757 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
5758 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
5759 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005760 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005761 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005762 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005763 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
5764 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
5765 still not served and not pollute the servers.
5766
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005767 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
5768 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005769 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
5770 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
5771 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
5772 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
5773 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
5774 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005775 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005776
5777 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5778 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5779
5780 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
5781
5782
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005783option accept-invalid-http-request
5784no option accept-invalid-http-request
5785 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
5786 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5787 yes | yes | yes | no
5788 Arguments : none
5789
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005790 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005791 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005792 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005793 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5794 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5795 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5796 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5797 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005798 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
5799 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
5800 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
5801 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005802 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005803 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02005804 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
5805 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
5806 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005807
5808 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5809 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5810 been confirmed.
5811
5812 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5813 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005814 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
5815 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005816 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5817
5818 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5819 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5820
5821 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
5822 stats socket.
5823
5824
5825option accept-invalid-http-response
5826no option accept-invalid-http-response
5827 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
5828 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5829 yes | no | yes | yes
5830 Arguments : none
5831
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005832 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005833 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005834 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005835 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5836 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5837 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5838 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5839 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005840 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
5841 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
5842 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005843
5844 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5845 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5846 been confirmed.
5847
5848 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5849 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
5850 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
5851 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5852
5853 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5854 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5855
5856 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
5857 stats socket.
5858
5859
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005860option allbackups
5861no option allbackups
5862 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
5863 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5864 yes | no | yes | yes
5865 Arguments : none
5866
5867 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
5868 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
5869 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
5870 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
5871 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
5872 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
5873 order between the backup servers anymore.
5874
5875 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
5876 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
5877
5878 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5879 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5880
5881
5882option checkcache
5883no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08005884 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005885 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5886 yes | no | yes | yes
5887 Arguments : none
5888
5889 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
5890 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005891 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005892 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
5893 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005894 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005895
5896 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005897 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005898 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005899 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
5900 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005901 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005902 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01005903 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
5904 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005905 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01005906 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
5907 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005908 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005909 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
5910 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
5911 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
5912 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
5913 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
5914 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
5915 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
5916 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
5917 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
5918
5919 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005920 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005921 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005922 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005923 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
5924
5925 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
5926 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005927 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005928 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005929
5930 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5931 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5932
5933
5934option clitcpka
5935no option clitcpka
5936 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
5937 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5938 yes | yes | yes | no
5939 Arguments : none
5940
5941 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5942 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005943 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005944 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5945
5946 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5947 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5948 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5949 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5950
5951 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5952 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5953 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5954 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5955 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5956
5957 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5958
5959 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5960 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5961 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
5962
5963 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5964 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5965
5966 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
5967
5968
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005969option contstats
5970 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
5971 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5972 yes | yes | yes | no
5973 Arguments : none
5974
5975 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
5976 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
5977 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
5978 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01005979 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
5980 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
5981 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
5982 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
5983 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005984
5985
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005986option dontlog-normal
5987no option dontlog-normal
5988 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
5989 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5990 yes | yes | yes | no
5991 Arguments : none
5992
5993 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
5994 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
5995 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
5996 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
5997 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
5998 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
5999 logged.
6000
6001 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
6002 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
6003 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
6004
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006005 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006006 logging.
6007
6008
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006009option dontlognull
6010no option dontlognull
6011 Enable or disable logging of null connections
6012 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6013 yes | yes | yes | no
6014 Arguments : none
6015
6016 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
6017 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
6018 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
6019 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
6020 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
6021 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006022 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
6023 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
6024 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006025
6026 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006027 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006028 would not be logged.
6029
6030 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6031 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6032
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006033 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
6034 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006035
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006036
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006037option forceclose (deprecated)
6038no option forceclose (deprecated)
6039 This is an alias for "option httpclose". Thus this option is deprecated.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006040
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006041 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006042
6043
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006044option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006045 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
6046 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6047 yes | yes | yes | yes
6048 Arguments :
6049 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6050 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006051 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006052 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006053
6054 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
6055 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
6056 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
6057 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
6058 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
6059 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
6060 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006061 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
6062 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6063 possible that the client has already brought one.
6064
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006065 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006066 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006067 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006068 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006069 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006070 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006071
6072 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6073 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6074 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6075 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6076 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6077 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6078 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6079
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006080 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
6081 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
6082 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
6083 are under the control of the end-user.
6084
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006085 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006086 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6087 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006088 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
6089 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
6090 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006091
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006092 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006093 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
6094 frontend www
6095 mode http
6096 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
6097
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006098 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
6099 backend www
6100 mode http
6101 option forwardfor header X-Client
6102
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006103 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006104 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006105
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006106
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006107option http-buffer-request
6108no option http-buffer-request
6109 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
6110 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6111 yes | yes | yes | yes
6112 Arguments : none
6113
6114 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
6115 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
6116 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
6117 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
6118 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
6119 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
6120 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
6121 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01006122 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered transmissions between
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006123 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
6124 default.
6125
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01006126 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006127
6128
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006129option http-ignore-probes
6130no option http-ignore-probes
6131 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
6132 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6133 yes | yes | yes | no
6134 Arguments : none
6135
6136 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
6137 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
6138 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
6139 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
6140 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
6141 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
6142 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
6143 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
6144 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006145 was received over a connection before it was closed;
6146 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006147 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
6148
6149 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
6150 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
6151 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
6152 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
6153 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
6154 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
6155 are often the only way to detect them.
6156
6157 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6158 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6159
6160 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
6161
6162
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006163option http-keep-alive
6164no option http-keep-alive
6165 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
6166 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6167 yes | yes | yes | yes
6168 Arguments : none
6169
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006170 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6171 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006172 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6173 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
6174 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
6175 This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when
6176 another mode was used in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006177
6178 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
6179 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006180 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
6181 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
6182 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
6183 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
6184 situations where this option may be useful :
6185
6186 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006187 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006188
6189 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
6190 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
6191
6192 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
6193 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
6194 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
6195 request.
6196
6197 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
6198 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006199 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
6200 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
6201 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006202
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006203 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6204 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6205 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6206 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
6207 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6208 not set.
6209
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01006210 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006211 http-server-close" or "option http-tunnel". When backend and frontend options
6212 differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006213
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006214 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006215 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01006216 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006217
6218
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006219option http-no-delay
6220no option http-no-delay
6221 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
6222 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6223 yes | yes | yes | yes
6224 Arguments : none
6225
6226 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
6227 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
6228 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
6229 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
6230 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
6231 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
6232 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
6233 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
6234 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
6235 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
6236 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
6237 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
6238 affected.
6239
6240 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
6241 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
6242 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
6243 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
6244 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
6245 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
6246 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
6247 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
6248 latency environments.
6249
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006250 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
6251
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006252
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006253option http-pretend-keepalive
6254no option http-pretend-keepalive
6255 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
6256 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006257 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006258 Arguments : none
6259
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006260 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006261 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
6262 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
6263 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
6264 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
6265 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
6266 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
6267 consider the response complete.
6268
6269 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
6270 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
6271 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
6272 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006273 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006274 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
6275
6276 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
6277 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
6278 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
6279 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
6280 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
6281 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
6282 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
6283
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006284 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
6285 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
6286 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6287 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
6288 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
6289 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006290
6291 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6292 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6293
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006294 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006295 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006296
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006297
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006298option http-server-close
6299no option http-server-close
6300 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
6301 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6302 yes | yes | yes | yes
6303 Arguments : none
6304
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006305 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6306 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6307 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6308 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006309 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
6310 Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the
6311 server side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and
6312 pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client
6313 side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save
6314 server resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits
6315 non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients
6316 if they conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers
6317 do not always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close"
6318 in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A
6319 workaround consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006320
6321 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6322 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6323 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6324 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006325 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6326 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006327
6328 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6329 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006330 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option http-tunnel"
6331 or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how
6332 this option combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006333
6334 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6335 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6336
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006337 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
6338 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006339
6340
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01006341option http-tunnel (deprecated)
6342no option http-tunnel (deprecated)
6343 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006344 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02006345 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006346 Arguments : none
6347
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01006348 Warning : Because it cannot work in HTTP/2, this option is deprecated and it
6349 is only supported on legacy HTTP frontends. In HTX, it is ignored and a
6350 warning is emitted during HAProxy startup.
6351
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006352 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6353 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6354 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6355 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006356 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006357
6358 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006359 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006360 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
6361 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
6362 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
6363 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
6364 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
6365 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
6366 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006367
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02006368 This option may be set on frontend and listen sections. Using it on a backend
6369 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during the startup. It
6370 is a frontend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6371 backend.
6372
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006373 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6374 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6375
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006376 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
6377 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006378
6379
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006380option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006381no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006382 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
6383 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6384 yes | yes | yes | no
6385 Arguments : none
6386
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00006387 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006388 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
6389 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
6390 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
6391 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
6392 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
6393 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
6394
6395 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
6396 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006397 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
6398 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
6399 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006400
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01006401 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
6402 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
6403 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
6404 front of an existing proxy.
6405
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006406 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
6407
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006408 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006409
6410
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006411option http-use-htx
6412no option http-use-htx
6413 Switch to the new HTX internal representation for HTTP protocol elements
6414 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6415 yes | yes | yes | yes
6416 Arguments : none
6417
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006418 Historically, the HTTP protocol is processed as-is. Inserting, deleting, or
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006419 modifying a header field requires to rewrite the affected part in the buffer
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006420 and to move the buffer's tail accordingly. This mode is known as the legacy
6421 HTTP mode. Since this principle has deep roots in haproxy, the HTTP/2
6422 protocol is converted to HTTP/1.1 before being processed this way. It also
6423 results in the inability to establish HTTP/2 connections to servers because
6424 of the loss of HTTP/2 semantics in the HTTP/1 representation.
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006425
6426 HTX is the name of a totally new native internal representation for the HTTP
6427 protocol, that is agnostic to the version and aims at preserving semantics
6428 all along the chain. It relies on a fast parsing, tokenizing and indexing of
6429 the protocol elements so that no more memory moves are necessary and that
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006430 most elements are directly accessed. It supports using either HTTP/1 or
6431 HTTP/2 on any side regardless of the other side's version. It also supports
6432 upgrades from TCP to HTTP and implicit ones from HTTP/1 to HTTP/2 (matching
6433 the HTTP/2 preface).
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006434
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006435 This option indicates that HTX needs to be used. Since the version 2.0-dev3,
6436 the HTX is the default mode. To switch back on the legacy HTTP mode, the
6437 option must be explicitly disabled using the "no" prefix. For prior versions,
6438 the feature has incomplete functional coverage, so it is not enabled by
6439 default.
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006440
6441 See also : "mode http"
6442
6443
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006444option httpchk
6445option httpchk <uri>
6446option httpchk <method> <uri>
6447option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
6448 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
6449 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6450 yes | no | yes | yes
6451 Arguments :
6452 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
6453 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
6454 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
6455 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
6456 ones.
6457
6458 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
6459 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
6460 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
6461
6462 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
6463 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
6464 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
6465 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
6466 after "\r\n" following the version string.
6467
6468 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
6469 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
6470 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
6471 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
6472 the lack of any response.
6473
6474 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
6475
6476 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
6477 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
6478 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
6479
6480 Examples :
6481 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
6482 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
6483 backend https_relay
6484 mode tcp
6485 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
6486 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
6487
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09006488 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
6489 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
6490 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006491
6492
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006493option httpclose
6494no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006495 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006496 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6497 yes | yes | yes | yes
6498 Arguments : none
6499
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006500 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6501 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6502 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6503 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006504 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006505
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006506 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
6507 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
6508 alos check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
6509 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
6510 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006511
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006512 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
6513 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
6514 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006515
6516 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6517 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01006518 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006519 "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please check section 4
6520 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
6521 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006522
6523 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6524 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6525
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006526 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006527
6528
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006529option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006530 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
6531 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01006532 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006533 Arguments :
6534 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
6535 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
6536 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006537 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006538 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006539
6540 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6541 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6542 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
6543 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
6544 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
6545 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
6546 ports.
6547
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01006548 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
6549 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006550
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006551 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
6552
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006553 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006554
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006555
6556option http_proxy
6557no option http_proxy
6558 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
6559 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6560 yes | yes | yes | yes
6561 Arguments : none
6562
6563 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
6564 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
6565 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
6566 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
6567 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
6568
6569 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
6570 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006571 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
6572 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006573
6574 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6575 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6576
6577 Example :
6578 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
6579 backend direct_forward
6580 option httpclose
6581 option http_proxy
6582
6583 See also : "option httpclose"
6584
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006585
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006586option independent-streams
6587no option independent-streams
6588 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006589 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6590 yes | yes | yes | yes
6591 Arguments : none
6592
6593 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
6594 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
6595 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
6596 receive data or not.
6597
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006598 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006599 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
6600 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
6601 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
6602 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
6603 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
6604 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
6605 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
6606 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
6607 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
6608 socket buffers.
6609
6610 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
6611 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
6612 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
6613 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
6614 slow lines, so use it with caution.
6615
Lukas Tribus745f15e2018-11-08 12:41:42 +01006616 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independant-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006617 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
6618 deprecated.
6619
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006620 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006621
6622
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02006623option ldap-check
6624 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
6625 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6626 yes | no | yes | yes
6627 Arguments : none
6628
6629 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
6630 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
6631 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
6632 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
6633
6634 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
6635 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
6636
6637 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
6638 configure it.
6639
6640 Example :
6641 option ldap-check
6642
6643 See also : "option httpchk"
6644
6645
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006646option external-check
6647 Use external processes for server health checks
6648 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6649 yes | no | yes | yes
6650
6651 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
6652 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
6653 command".
6654
6655 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
6656
6657 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
6658
6659
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006660option log-health-checks
6661no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006662 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006663 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6664 yes | no | yes | yes
6665 Arguments : none
6666
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006667 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
6668 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
6669 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006670
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006671 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
6672 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
6673 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
6674 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
6675 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
6676
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006677 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006678 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006679
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006680 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
6681 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
6682 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006683
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006684
6685option log-separate-errors
6686no option log-separate-errors
6687 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
6688 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6689 yes | yes | yes | no
6690 Arguments : none
6691
6692 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
6693 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
6694 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
6695 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
6696 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
6697 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
6698 provides very important information.
6699
6700 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
6701 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
6702 error logs.
6703
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006704 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006705 logging.
6706
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006707
6708option logasap
6709no option logasap
6710 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
6711 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6712 yes | yes | yes | no
6713 Arguments : none
6714
6715 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
6716 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
6717 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
6718 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
6719 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
6720 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
6721 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006722 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006723 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
6724 bytes are expected to be transferred.
6725
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006726 Examples :
6727 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
6728 mode http
6729 option httplog
6730 option logasap
6731 log 192.168.2.200 local3
6732
6733 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
6734 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
6735 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
6736 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
6737
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006738 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006739 logging.
6740
6741
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006742option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006743 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006744 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6745 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006746 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006747 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
6748 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006749 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006750
6751 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
6752 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006753 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006754 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
6755 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
6756 in the MySQL table, like this :
6757
6758 USE mysql;
6759 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
6760 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
6761
6762 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006763 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006764 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
6765 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
6766 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
6767 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
6768 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
6769 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
6770 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
6771
6772 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
6773 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006774
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02006775 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006776
6777 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
6778 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
6779 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6780 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006781 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
6782 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006783
6784 See also: "option httpchk"
6785
6786
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006787option nolinger
6788no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006789 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006790 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6791 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006792 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006793
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006794 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006795 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
6796 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
6797 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
6798 connections.
6799
6800 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
6801 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
6802 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
6803 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
6804 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
6805 this too.
6806
6807 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
6808 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
6809 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
6810
6811 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
6812 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
6813 for servers.
6814
6815 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6816 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6817
6818
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006819option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
6820 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
6821 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6822 yes | yes | yes | yes
6823 Arguments :
6824 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6825 matching <network>
6826 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
6827 header name.
6828
6829 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
6830 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
6831 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
6832 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
6833 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
6834 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
6835 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
6836 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
6837 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6838 possible that the client has already brought one.
6839
6840 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
6841 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
6842 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
6843 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
6844 header and requires different one.
6845
6846 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6847 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6848 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6849 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6850 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6851 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6852 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6853
6854 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
6855 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6856 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
6857 both are defined.
6858
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006859 Examples :
6860 # Original Destination address
6861 frontend www
6862 mode http
6863 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
6864
6865 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
6866 backend www
6867 mode http
6868 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
6869
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006870 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006871
6872
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006873option persist
6874no option persist
6875 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
6876 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6877 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006878 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006879
6880 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
6881 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
6882 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
6883 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
6884 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
6885 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
6886 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
6887 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
6888 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
6889 redirected to another valid server.
6890
6891 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6892 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6893
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006894 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006895
6896
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01006897option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
6898 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
6899 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6900 yes | no | yes | yes
6901 Arguments :
6902 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
6903 PostgreSQL server.
6904
6905 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
6906 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
6907 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
6908 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
6909
6910 See also: "option httpchk"
6911
6912
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006913option prefer-last-server
6914no option prefer-last-server
6915 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
6916 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6917 yes | no | yes | yes
6918 Arguments : none
6919
6920 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
6921 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
6922 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
6923 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
6924 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
6925 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
6926 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
6927 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
6928 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006929 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
6930 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02006931 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
6932 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
6933 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006934 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
6935 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
6936 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006937
6938 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6939 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6940
6941 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
6942
6943
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006944option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006945option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006946no option redispatch
6947 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6948 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6949 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006950 Arguments :
6951 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
6952 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
6953 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006954 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006955 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006956 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006957 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
6958 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
6959 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
6960
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006961
6962 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6963 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6964 be able to access the service anymore.
6965
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01006966 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
6967 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006968
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006969 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006970 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6971 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006972
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006973 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
6974 "redisp" keywords.
6975
6976 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6977 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6978
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006979 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006980
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006981
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006982option redis-check
6983 Use redis health checks for server testing
6984 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6985 yes | no | yes | yes
6986 Arguments : none
6987
6988 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
6989 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6990 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
6991 find the "+PONG" response message.
6992
6993 Example :
6994 option redis-check
6995
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006996 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006997
6998
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006999option smtpchk
7000option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
7001 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
7002 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7003 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007004 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007005 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02007006 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007007 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
7008
7009 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
7010 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
7011 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
7012
7013 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
7014 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
7015 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
7016 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
7017 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
7018 dead server.
7019
7020 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
7021 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007022 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007023 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
7024
7025 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
7026 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
7027 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
7028 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02007029 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007030
7031 Example :
7032 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
7033
7034 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
7035
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007036
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02007037option socket-stats
7038no option socket-stats
7039
7040 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
7041 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7042 yes | yes | yes | no
7043
7044 Arguments : none
7045
7046
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007047option splice-auto
7048no option splice-auto
7049 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
7050 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7051 yes | yes | yes | yes
7052 Arguments : none
7053
7054 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
7055 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007056 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007057 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007058 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007059 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
7060 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
7061 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
7062 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7063
7064 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
7065 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
7066 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
7067 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
7068 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
7069 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
7070 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
7071 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
7072 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
7073 keyword.
7074
7075 Example :
7076 option splice-auto
7077
7078 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7079 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7080
7081 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
7082 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7083
7084
7085option splice-request
7086no option splice-request
7087 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
7088 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7089 yes | yes | yes | yes
7090 Arguments : none
7091
7092 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007093 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007094 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7095 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7096 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7097 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7098
7099 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7100
7101 Example :
7102 option splice-request
7103
7104 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7105 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7106
7107 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
7108 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7109
7110
7111option splice-response
7112no option splice-response
7113 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
7114 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7115 yes | yes | yes | yes
7116 Arguments : none
7117
7118 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007119 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007120 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7121 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7122 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7123 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7124
7125 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7126
7127 Example :
7128 option splice-response
7129
7130 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7131 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7132
7133 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
7134 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7135
7136
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01007137option spop-check
7138 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
7139 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7140 no | no | no | yes
7141 Arguments : none
7142
7143 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
7144 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7145 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
7146 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
7147
7148 Example :
7149 option spop-check
7150
7151 See also : "option httpchk"
7152
7153
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007154option srvtcpka
7155no option srvtcpka
7156 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
7157 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7158 yes | no | yes | yes
7159 Arguments : none
7160
7161 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7162 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007163 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007164 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7165
7166 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7167 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7168 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7169 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7170
7171 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7172 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7173 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7174 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7175 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7176
7177 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7178
7179 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7180 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7181 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
7182
7183 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7184 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7185
7186 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
7187
7188
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007189option ssl-hello-chk
7190 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
7191 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7192 yes | no | yes | yes
7193 Arguments : none
7194
7195 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
7196 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
7197 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
7198 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
7199 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
7200 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
7201 hello message.
7202
7203 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
7204 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
7205 messages, which is appreciable.
7206
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007207 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
7208 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
7209 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007210
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007211 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
7212
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007213
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007214option tcp-check
7215 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
7216 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7217 yes | no | yes | yes
7218
7219 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
7220 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
7221
7222 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
7223 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
7224 attempt, which remains the default mode.
7225
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007226 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007227 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
7228 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
7229 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
7230 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
7231 only.
7232
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007233 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007234 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
7235 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
7236 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
7237 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
7238
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007239 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007240 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
7241 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007242 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007243 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
7244 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
7245 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
7246 the respective protocols.
7247 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007248 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007249
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007250 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
7251 script.
7252
7253 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
7254 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
7255 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
7256 The "comment" is of course optional.
7257
7258
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007259 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007260 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007261 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007262 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007263
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007264 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007265 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007266 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007267
7268 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
7269 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007270 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007271 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007272 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007273 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02007274 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007275 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007276 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7277 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007278 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007279 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7280 tcp-check expect string +OK
7281
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007282 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007283 (send many headers before analyzing)
7284 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007285 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007286 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
7287 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
7288 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
7289 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007290 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007291
7292
7293 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
7294
7295
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007296option tcp-smart-accept
7297no option tcp-smart-accept
7298 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
7299 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7300 yes | yes | yes | no
7301 Arguments : none
7302
7303 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
7304 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
7305 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
7306 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
7307 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
7308 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
7309
7310 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
7311 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
7312 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
7313 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
7314
7315 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
7316 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
7317 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007318 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007319
7320 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
7321 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
7322 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
7323
7324 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
7325 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
7326 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
7327
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02007328 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
7329
7330
7331option tcp-smart-connect
7332no option tcp-smart-connect
7333 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
7334 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7335 yes | no | yes | yes
7336 Arguments : none
7337
7338 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
7339 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
7340 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
7341 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
7342 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
7343
7344 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
7345 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
7346 complex.
7347
7348 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
7349 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
7350 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
7351
7352 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7353 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7354
7355 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
7356
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007357
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007358option tcpka
7359 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
7360 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7361 yes | yes | yes | yes
7362 Arguments : none
7363
7364 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7365 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007366 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007367 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7368
7369 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7370 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7371 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7372 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7373
7374 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7375 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7376 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7377 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7378 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7379
7380 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7381
7382 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
7383 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
7384 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
7385 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
7386 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
7387 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
7388 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
7389 backends.
7390
7391 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
7392
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007393
7394option tcplog
7395 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
7396 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01007397 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007398 Arguments : none
7399
7400 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
7401 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
7402 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
7403 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
7404 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
7405 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
7406 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
7407 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
7408
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007409 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
7410
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007411 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007412
7413
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007414option transparent
7415no option transparent
7416 Enable client-side transparent proxying
7417 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01007418 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007419 Arguments : none
7420
7421 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
7422 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
7423 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
7424 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
7425 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
7426 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
7427 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
7428 appropriate server.
7429
7430 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
7431 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
7432
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01007433 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007434 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007435
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007436
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007437external-check command <command>
7438 Executable to run when performing an external-check
7439 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7440 yes | no | yes | yes
7441
7442 Arguments :
7443 <command> is the external command to run
7444
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007445 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
7446
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007447 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007448
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007449 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
7450 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
7451 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
7452 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
7453 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
7454 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007455
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01007456 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
7457
7458 Environment variables :
7459 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
7460 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
7461
7462 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
7463
7464 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
7465
7466 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
7467 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
7468 for a UNIX socket).
7469
7470 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
7471
7472 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
7473
7474 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
7475
7476 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
7477
7478 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
7479
7480 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
7481 socket).
7482
7483 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
7484 the command may be set using "external-check path".
7485
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007486 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
7487 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
7488 failed.
7489
7490 Example :
7491 external-check command /bin/true
7492
7493 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
7494
7495
7496external-check path <path>
7497 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
7498 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7499 yes | no | yes | yes
7500
7501 Arguments :
7502 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
7503
7504 The default path is "".
7505
7506 Example :
7507 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
7508
7509 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
7510 "external-check command"
7511
7512
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007513persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007514persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007515 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
7516 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7517 yes | no | yes | yes
7518 Arguments :
7519 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007520 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
7521 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007522
7523 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
7524 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007525 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007526 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
7527 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
7528 forwarded to this server.
7529
7530 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
7531 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
7532 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007533 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007534 a single "listen" section.
7535
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007536 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
7537 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
7538 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
7539
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007540 Example :
7541 listen tse-farm
7542 bind :3389
7543 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
7544 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7545 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
7546 # apply RDP cookie persistence
7547 persist rdp-cookie
7548 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007549 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007550 balance rdp-cookie
7551 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
7552 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
7553
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09007554 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
7555 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007556
7557
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007558rate-limit sessions <rate>
7559 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
7560 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7561 yes | yes | yes | no
7562 Arguments :
7563 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
7564 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
7565
7566 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
7567 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
7568 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
7569 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
7570 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
7571 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
7572
7573 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
7574 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
7575 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
7576 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
7577
7578 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
7579 listen smtp
7580 mode tcp
7581 bind :25
7582 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02007583 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007584
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02007585 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
7586 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
7587 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007588
7589 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
7590
7591
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007592redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7593redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7594redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007595 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
7596 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7597 no | yes | yes | yes
7598
7599 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01007600 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007601
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007602 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007603 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007604 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
7605 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
7606 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007607
7608 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
7609 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
7610 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
7611 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
7612 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007613 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
7614 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
7615 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
7616 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007617
7618 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
7619 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
7620 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
7621 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
7622 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
7623 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007624 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007625 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007626 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
7627 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
7628 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007629
7630 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007631 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
7632 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
7633 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02007634 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007635 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
7636 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
7637 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
7638 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007639
7640 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007641 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007642
7643 - "drop-query"
7644 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
7645 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
7646 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
7647 with a location-type redirect.
7648
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007649 - "append-slash"
7650 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
7651 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
7652 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
7653 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
7654
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007655 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
7656 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
7657 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
7658 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
7659 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
7660 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
7661 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
7662
7663 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
7664 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
7665 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
7666 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
7667 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
7668 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
7669 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007670
7671 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
7672 acl clear dst_port 80
7673 acl secure dst_port 8080
7674 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007675 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007676 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007677 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
7678
7679 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007680 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
7681 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
7682 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007683 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007684
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007685 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
7686 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
7687 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
7688
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007689 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01007690 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007691
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007692 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02007693 http-request redirect code 301 location \
7694 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
7695 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007696
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007697 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007698
7699
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007700redisp (deprecated)
7701redispatch (deprecated)
7702 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7703 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7704 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007705 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007706
7707 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7708 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7709 be able to access the service anymore.
7710
7711 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
7712 redistribute them to a working server.
7713
7714 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
7715 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7716 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007717
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007718 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
7719 "option redispatch" instead.
7720
7721 See also : "option redispatch"
7722
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007723
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007724reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007725 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
7726 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7727 no | yes | yes | yes
7728 Arguments :
7729 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7730 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007731 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007732
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007733 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7734 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7735
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007736 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7737 the last header of an HTTP request.
7738
7739 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7740 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7741 responses.
7742
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007743 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
7744 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
7745 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
7746
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007747 See also: "rspadd", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation,
7748 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007749
7750
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007751reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7752reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007753 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7754 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7755 no | yes | yes | yes
7756 Arguments :
7757 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7758 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7759 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7760 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7761 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7762 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
7763 ignores case.
7764
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007765 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7766 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7767
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007768 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7769 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
7770 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7771 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007772 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007773
7774 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7775 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7776
7777 Example :
7778 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
7779 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7780 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7781
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007782 See also: "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header
7783 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007784
7785
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007786reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7787reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007788 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
7789 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7790 no | yes | yes | yes
7791 Arguments :
7792 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7793 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7794 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7795 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7796 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
7797 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
7798
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007799 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7800 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7801
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007802 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
7803 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
7804 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
7805 next servers.
7806
7807 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7808 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7809 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7810
7811 Example :
7812 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
7813 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
7814 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
7815
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007816 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", "http-request", section 6 about
7817 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007818
7819
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007820reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7821reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007822 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7823 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7824 no | yes | yes | yes
7825 Arguments :
7826 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7827 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7828 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7829 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7830 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7831 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
7832 case.
7833
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007834 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7835 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7836
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007837 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7838 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
7839 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7840 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007841 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007842
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007843 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007844 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007845 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007846
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007847 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7848 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7849
7850 Example :
7851 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
7852 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7853 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7854
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007855 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7856 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007857
7858
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007859reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7860reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007861 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
7862 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7863 no | yes | yes | yes
7864 Arguments :
7865 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7866 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7867 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7868 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7869 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7870 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
7871 case.
7872
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007873 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7874 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7875
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007876 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7877 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
7878 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
7879 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7880
7881 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7882 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7883
7884 Example :
7885 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
7886 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
7887 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7888 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7889
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007890 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7891 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007892
7893
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007894reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7895reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007896 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
7897 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7898 no | yes | yes | yes
7899 Arguments :
7900 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7901 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7902 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7903 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7904 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
7905 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
7906
7907 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7908 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7909 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7910 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007911 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007912
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007913 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7914 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7915
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007916 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
7917 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
7918 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
7919
7920 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7921 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7922 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7923 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
7924 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7925
7926 Example :
7927 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007928 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007929 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
7930 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
7931
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007932 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", "http-request",
7933 section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007934
7935
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007936reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7937reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007938 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
7939 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7940 no | yes | yes | yes
7941 Arguments :
7942 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7943 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7944 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7945 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7946 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7947 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
7948 ignores case.
7949
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007950 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7951 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7952
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007953 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7954 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007955 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
7956 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
7957 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007958 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
7959 not set.
7960
7961 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
7962 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
7963 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
7964 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
7965 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
7966
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007967 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007968 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavor of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007969 # block all others.
7970 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
7971 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
7972
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007973 # block bad guys
7974 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
7975 reqitarpit . if badguys
7976
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007977 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", "http-request", section 6
7978 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007979
7980
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007981retries <value>
7982 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
7983 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7984 yes | no | yes | yes
7985 Arguments :
7986 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
7987 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
7988 default value is 3.
7989
7990 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
7991 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
7992 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
7993
7994 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007995 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
7996 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007997
7998 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
7999 server even if a cookie references a different server.
8000
8001 See also : "option redispatch"
8002
8003
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008004retry-on [list of keywords]
8005 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request
8006 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8007 yes | no | yes | yes
8008 Arguments :
8009 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
8010 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
8011 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
8012 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
8013
8014 none never retry
8015
8016 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
8017 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
8018
8019 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
8020 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
8021 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
8022 request timeout on the server side, poor network
8023 condition, or a server crash or restart while
8024 processing the request.
8025
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02008026 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
8027 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
8028 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
8029 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
8030 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
8031 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
8032 overflow attack for example).
8033
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008034 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
8035 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
8036 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
8037 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
8038 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
8039 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
8040 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
8041 amplify denial of service attacks.
8042
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02008043 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
8044 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
8045 considered to be safe to retry.
8046
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008047 <status> any HTTP status code among "404" (Not Found), "408"
8048 (Request Timeout), "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server
8049 Error), "501" (Not Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway),
8050 "503" (Service Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
8051
8052 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
8053 not cumulative.
8054
8055 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
8056 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
8057 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
8058 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
8059
8060 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
8061 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
8062 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
8063 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
8064 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
8065 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
8066 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
8067 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
8068 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
8069 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
8070 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
8071 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
8072
8073 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
8074 should not use this directive.
8075
8076 The default is "conn-failure".
8077
8078 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
8079
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008080rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008081 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
8082 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8083 no | yes | yes | yes
8084 Arguments :
8085 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
8086 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008087 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008088
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008089 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8090 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8091
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008092 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
8093 the last header of an HTTP response.
8094
8095 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8096 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8097 responses.
8098
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008099 See also: "rspdel" "reqadd", "http-response", section 6 about HTTP header
8100 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008101
8102
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008103rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
8104rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008105 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
8106 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8107 no | yes | yes | yes
8108 Arguments :
8109 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8110 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
8111 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
8112 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
8113 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
8114 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
8115 ignores case.
8116
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008117 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8118 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8119
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008120 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
8121 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008122 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008123 client.
8124
8125 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8126 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8127 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
8128
8129 Example :
8130 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02008131 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008132
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008133 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", "http-response", section 6 about
8134 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008135
8136
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008137rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
8138rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008139 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
8140 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8141 no | yes | yes | yes
8142 Arguments :
8143 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8144 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
8145 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
8146 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
8147 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
8148 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
8149 ignores case.
8150
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008151 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8152 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8153
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008154 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
8155 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
8156 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
8157 case-sensitive.
8158
8159 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008160 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
8161 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
8162 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008163
8164 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
8165 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
8166
8167 Example :
8168 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
8169 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
8170
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008171 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", "http-response", section 6 about
8172 HTTP header manipulation and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008173
8174
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008175rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
8176rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008177 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
8178 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8179 no | yes | yes | yes
8180 Arguments :
8181 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8182 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
8183 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
8184 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
8185 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
8186 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
8187 ignores case.
8188
8189 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
8190 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
8191 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
8192 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008193 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008194
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008195 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8196 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8197
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008198 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
8199 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
8200 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
8201
8202 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8203 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8204 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
8205 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
8206 are not case-sensitive.
8207
8208 Example :
8209 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
8210 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
8211
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008212 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", "http-response", section 6 about
8213 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008214
8215
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008216server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008217 Declare a server in a backend
8218 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8219 no | no | yes | yes
8220 Arguments :
8221 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008222 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008223 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008224
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008225 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
8226 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
8227 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
8228 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02008229 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
8230 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
8231 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
8232 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
8233 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008234 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
8235 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
8236 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
8237 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
8238 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8239 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8240 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008241 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02008242 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
8243 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
8244 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
8245 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
8246 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
8247 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008248 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8249 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01008250 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
8251 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008252
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008253 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008254 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
8255 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
8256 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
8257 adding this value to the client's port.
8258
8259 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
8260 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008261 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008262
8263 Examples :
8264 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
8265 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008266 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008267 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
8268 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
8269 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008270
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02008271 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
8272 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
8273 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
8274 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
8275 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
8276
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008277 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
8278 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008279
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008280server-state-file-name [<file>]
8281 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
8282 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
8283 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
8284 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
8285 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
8286 global directive "server-state-file-base".
8287
8288 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
8289 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
8290
8291 global
8292 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
8293
8294 backend bk
8295 load-server-state-from-file
8296
8297 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
8298 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008299
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02008300server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
8301 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
8302 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
8303 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8304 no | no | yes | yes
8305
8306 Arguments:
8307 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
8308
8309 <num | range>
8310 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
8311 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
8312 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
8313 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
8314
8315 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
8316
8317 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
8318
8319 <params*>
8320 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
8321 keyword.
8322
8323 Examples:
8324 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
8325 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
8326 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
8327
8328 # or
8329 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
8330
8331 # would be equivalent to:
8332 server srv1 google.com:80 check
8333 server srv2 google.com:80 check
8334 server srv3 google.com:80 check
8335
8336
8337
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008338source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008339source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008340source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008341 Set the source address for outgoing connections
8342 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8343 yes | no | yes | yes
8344 Arguments :
8345 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
8346 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008347
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008348 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008349 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
8350 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
8351 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
8352 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
8353 supported prefixes are :
8354 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8355 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8356 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008357 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02008358 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8359 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008360
8361 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
8362 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008363 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
8364 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
8365 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008366
8367 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
8368 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
8369 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
8370 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
8371 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
8372 <addr>.
8373
8374 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
8375 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
8376 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
8377 port.
8378
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008379 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
8380 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
8381 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
8382 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01008383 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008384 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
8385 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
8386 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
8387 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
8388 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
8389 HTTP header.
8390
8391 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
8392 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008393 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008394 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
8395 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8396 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
8397 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
8398 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
8399 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
8400 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
8401
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008402 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
8403 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
8404 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
8405 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
8406 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
8407 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
8408
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008409 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
8410 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
8411 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
8412 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
8413
8414 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
8415 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
8416 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
8417 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
8418 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
8419 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
8420
8421 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
8422 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
8423 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
8424 there are two methods :
8425
8426 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
8427 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
8428 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
8429 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
8430 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
8431 of the client ranges may be used.
8432
8433 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
8434 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
8435 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
8436 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
8437 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
8438 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
8439 same session.
8440
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008441 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
8442 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
8443 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008444 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008445
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02008446 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
8447
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008448 Examples :
8449 backend private
8450 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
8451 source 192.168.1.200
8452
8453 backend transparent_ssl1
8454 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
8455 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8456
8457 backend transparent_ssl2
8458 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
8459 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
8460 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
8461
8462 backend transparent_ssl3
8463 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
8464 # is more conntrack-friendly.
8465 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8466
8467 backend transparent_smtp
8468 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
8469 # with Tproxy version 4.
8470 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
8471
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008472 backend transparent_http
8473 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
8474 # proxy.
8475 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
8476
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008477 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008478 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
8479
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008480
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008481srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8482 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
8483 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8484 yes | no | yes | yes
8485 Arguments :
8486 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8487 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8488 as explained at the top of this document.
8489
8490 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8491 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
8492 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
8493 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
8494 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
8495 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
8496 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
8497
8498 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8499 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8500 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
8501 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
8502 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008503 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008504 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008505 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008506
8507 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8508 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8509 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8510 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8511 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
8512 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8513
8514 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
8515 Please use "timeout server" instead.
8516
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008517 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
8518 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008519
8520
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008521stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
8522 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
8523 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008524 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008525
8526 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
8527 matched.
8528
8529 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
8530 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
8531
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008532 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8533 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008534 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008535
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01008536 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
8537 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
8538 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
8539 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008540
8541 Example :
8542 # statistics admin level only for localhost
8543 backend stats_localhost
8544 stats enable
8545 stats admin if LOCALHOST
8546
8547 Example :
8548 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
8549 backend stats_auth
8550 stats enable
8551 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
8552 stats admin if TRUE
8553
8554 Example :
8555 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
8556 userlist stats-auth
8557 group admin users admin
8558 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
8559 group readonly users haproxy
8560 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
8561
8562 backend stats_auth
8563 stats enable
8564 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
8565 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
8566 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
8567 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
8568
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008569 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
8570 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
8571 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008572
8573
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008574stats auth <user>:<passwd>
8575 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
8576 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008577 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008578 Arguments :
8579 <user> is a user name to grant access to
8580
8581 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
8582
8583 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
8584 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
8585 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
8586 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
8587 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
8588 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
8589
8590 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
8591 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
8592 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008593 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008594
8595 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
8596 report using "stats scope".
8597
8598 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8599 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8600 unobvious parameters.
8601
8602 Example :
8603 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8604 backend public_www
8605 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8606 stats enable
8607 stats hide-version
8608 stats scope .
8609 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008610 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008611 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8612 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8613
8614 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8615 backend private_monitoring
8616 stats enable
8617 stats uri /admin?stats
8618 stats refresh 5s
8619
8620 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
8621
8622
8623stats enable
8624 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
8625 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008626 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008627 Arguments : none
8628
8629 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
8630 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
8631 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
8632 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
8633 - stats auth : no authentication
8634 - stats scope : no restriction
8635
8636 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8637 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8638 unobvious parameters.
8639
8640 Example :
8641 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8642 backend public_www
8643 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8644 stats enable
8645 stats hide-version
8646 stats scope .
8647 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008648 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008649 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8650 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8651
8652 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8653 backend private_monitoring
8654 stats enable
8655 stats uri /admin?stats
8656 stats refresh 5s
8657
8658 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8659
8660
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008661stats hide-version
8662 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008663 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008664 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008665 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008666
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008667 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
8668 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
8669 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
8670 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
8671 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
8672 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008673
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008674 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8675 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8676 unobvious parameters.
8677
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008678 Example :
8679 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8680 backend public_www
8681 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008682 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008683 stats hide-version
8684 stats scope .
8685 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008686 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008687 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8688 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008689
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008690 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8691 backend private_monitoring
8692 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008693 stats uri /admin?stats
8694 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01008695
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008696 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008697
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008698
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02008699stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
8700 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8701 Access control for statistics
8702
8703 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8704 no | no | yes | yes
8705
8706 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
8707 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
8708 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
8709 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
8710 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
8711 should be asked to enter a username and password.
8712
8713 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
8714 instance.
8715
8716 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
8717 about ACL usage.
8718
8719
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008720stats realm <realm>
8721 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
8722 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008723 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008724 Arguments :
8725 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
8726 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
8727 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
8728
8729 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
8730 using a backslash ('\').
8731
8732 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
8733 only related to authentication.
8734
8735 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8736 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8737 unobvious parameters.
8738
8739 Example :
8740 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8741 backend public_www
8742 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8743 stats enable
8744 stats hide-version
8745 stats scope .
8746 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008747 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008748 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8749 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8750
8751 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8752 backend private_monitoring
8753 stats enable
8754 stats uri /admin?stats
8755 stats refresh 5s
8756
8757 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
8758
8759
8760stats refresh <delay>
8761 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
8762 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008763 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008764 Arguments :
8765 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
8766 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
8767 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
8768 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
8769 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
8770 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
8771
8772 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
8773 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
8774 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
8775 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
8776
8777 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8778 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8779 unobvious parameters.
8780
8781 Example :
8782 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8783 backend public_www
8784 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8785 stats enable
8786 stats hide-version
8787 stats scope .
8788 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008789 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008790 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8791 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8792
8793 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8794 backend private_monitoring
8795 stats enable
8796 stats uri /admin?stats
8797 stats refresh 5s
8798
8799 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8800
8801
8802stats scope { <name> | "." }
8803 Enable statistics and limit access scope
8804 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008805 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008806 Arguments :
8807 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
8808 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
8809 section in which the statement appears.
8810
8811 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
8812 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
8813 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
8814 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
8815 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
8816 exists.
8817
8818 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8819 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8820 unobvious parameters.
8821
8822 Example :
8823 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8824 backend public_www
8825 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8826 stats enable
8827 stats hide-version
8828 stats scope .
8829 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008830 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008831 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8832 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8833
8834 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8835 backend private_monitoring
8836 stats enable
8837 stats uri /admin?stats
8838 stats refresh 5s
8839
8840 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8841
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008842
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008843stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008844 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
8845 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008846 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008847
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008848 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008849 description from global section is automatically used instead.
8850
8851 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8852 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
8853
8854 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8855 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008856 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008857
8858 Example :
8859 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8860 backend private_monitoring
8861 stats enable
8862 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
8863 stats uri /admin?stats
8864 stats refresh 5s
8865
8866 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
8867 global section.
8868
8869
8870stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008871 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
8872 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8873 yes | yes | yes | yes
8874 Arguments : none
8875
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008876 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008877 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
8878 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
8879 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
8880 - IP (socket, server)
8881 - cookie (backend, server)
8882
8883 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8884 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008885 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008886
8887 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
8888
8889
8890stats show-node [ <name> ]
8891 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
8892 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008893 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008894 Arguments:
8895 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
8896 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
8897
8898 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8899 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008900 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008901
8902 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8903 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8904 unobvious parameters.
8905
8906 Example:
8907 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8908 backend private_monitoring
8909 stats enable
8910 stats show-node Europe-1
8911 stats uri /admin?stats
8912 stats refresh 5s
8913
8914 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
8915 section.
8916
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008917
8918stats uri <prefix>
8919 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
8920 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008921 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008922 Arguments :
8923 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
8924 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
8925 query string.
8926
8927 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
8928 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
8929 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
8930 possible to reach it in the application.
8931
8932 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008933 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008934 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
8935 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
8936 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
8937 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
8938
8939 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
8940 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
8941 an address or a port to statistics only.
8942
8943 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8944 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8945 unobvious parameters.
8946
8947 Example :
8948 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8949 backend public_www
8950 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8951 stats enable
8952 stats hide-version
8953 stats scope .
8954 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008955 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008956 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8957 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8958
8959 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8960 backend private_monitoring
8961 stats enable
8962 stats uri /admin?stats
8963 stats refresh 5s
8964
8965 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
8966
8967
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008968stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
8969 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008970 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008971 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008972
8973 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008974 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008975 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008976 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008977 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
8978
8979 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8980 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8981 the "stick-table" statement.
8982
8983 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
8984 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
8985 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
8986 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
8987 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
8988
8989 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8990 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
8991 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
8992 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
8993 transformation rules.
8994
8995 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8996 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8997 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8998 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8999 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9000 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9001 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9002
9003 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
9004 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
9005 ACL based conditions.
9006
9007 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
9008 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
9009 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
9010 matches can be used as fallbacks.
9011
9012 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
9013 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
9014 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
9015 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
9016
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009017 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9018 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009019 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009020
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009021 Example :
9022 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9023 # last 30 minutes
9024 backend pop
9025 mode tcp
9026 balance roundrobin
9027 stick store-request src
9028 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9029 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9030 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9031
9032 backend smtp
9033 mode tcp
9034 balance roundrobin
9035 stick match src table pop
9036 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9037 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9038
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009039 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009040 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009041
9042
9043stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9044 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
9045 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9046 no | no | yes | yes
9047
9048 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
9049 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
9050 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
9051 for writing more maintainable configurations.
9052
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009053 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9054 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009055 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009056
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009057 Examples :
9058 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01009059 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009060
9061 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
9062 stick match src table pop if !localhost
9063 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
9064
9065
9066 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
9067 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
9068 backend http
9069 mode http
9070 balance roundrobin
9071 stick on src table https
9072 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
9073 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
9074 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
9075
9076 backend https
9077 mode tcp
9078 balance roundrobin
9079 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9080 stick on src
9081 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9082 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9083
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009084 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009085
9086
9087stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9088 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
9089 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9090 no | no | yes | yes
9091
9092 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009093 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009094 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009095 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009096 server is selected.
9097
9098 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9099 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9100 the "stick-table" statement.
9101
9102 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9103 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9104 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
9105 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
9106 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
9107 address.
9108
9109 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9110 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
9111 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
9112 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
9113 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
9114 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
9115 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
9116 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
9117 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
9118 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
9119
9120 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9121 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9122 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9123 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9124 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9125 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9126 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9127
9128 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
9129 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9130 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
9131 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9132
9133 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
9134 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9135 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9136 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9137 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9138 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009139 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
9140 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9141 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9142 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9143 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9144 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009145
9146 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
9147 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
9148 the request.
9149
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009150 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9151 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009152 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009153
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009154 Example :
9155 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9156 # last 30 minutes
9157 backend pop
9158 mode tcp
9159 balance roundrobin
9160 stick store-request src
9161 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9162 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9163 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9164
9165 backend smtp
9166 mode tcp
9167 balance roundrobin
9168 stick match src table pop
9169 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9170 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9171
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009172 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009173 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009174
9175
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009176stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009177 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
9178 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08009179 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009180 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009181 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009182
9183 Arguments :
9184 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
9185 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
9186 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9187 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9188
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01009189 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
9190 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
9191 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9192 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9193
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009194 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
9195 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
9196 instance.
9197
9198 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
9199 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
9200 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
9201 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
9202 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
9203 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009204 to 32 characters.
9205
9206 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
9207 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
9208 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009209 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009210 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
9211 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009212
9213 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009214 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
9215 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009216 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
9217 increase.
9218
9219 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009220 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
9221 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
9222 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009223
9224 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
9225 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
9226 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
9227 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009228 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009229 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
9230 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
9231 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
9232 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
9233 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
9234 parameter (see below).
9235
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009236 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
9237 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
9238 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
9239 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
9240 soft restart.
9241
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02009242 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
9243 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009244
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009245 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
9246 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
9247 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
9248 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009249 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009250 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009251 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
9252 if not expiration delay is specified.
9253
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009254 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
9255 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
9256 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
9257 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009258 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
9259 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
9260 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
9261 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
9262 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
9263 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
9264 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
9265 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
9266 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
9267 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
9268 types and their arguments.
9269
9270 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
9271 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
9272 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
9273 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
9274
9275 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9276 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9277 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009278 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009279
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009280 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
9281 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9282 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009283 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009284 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009285 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009286
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009287 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9288 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9289 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
9290 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
9291
9292 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
9293 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9294 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
9295 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
9296 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
9297 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
9298
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009299 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9300 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
9301 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
9302 they were received.
9303
9304 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9305 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
9306 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
9307 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
9308 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
9309
9310 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9311 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9312 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9313 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
9314 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9315
9316 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9317 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
9318 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
9319
9320 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9321 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9322 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9323 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
9324 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9325
9326 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9327 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
9328 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
9329 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
9330 the client side.
9331
9332 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9333 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9334 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9335 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
9336 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
9337 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
9338 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
9339
9340 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9341 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
9342 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
9343 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
9344 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
9345 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009346 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009347
9348 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9349 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9350 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9351 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
9352 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
9353 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9354
9355 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009356 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009357 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
9358 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
9359
9360 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9361 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9362 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9363 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9364 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9365 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
9366 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
9367 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
9368 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
9369 recommended for better fairness.
9370
9371 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009372 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009373 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
9374 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
9375
9376 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
9377 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9378 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9379 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9380 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9381 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
9382 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
9383 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
9384 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
9385 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009386
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009387 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
9388 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009389 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
9390 reference it.
9391
9392 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
9393 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01009394 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
9395 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
9396 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009397
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009398 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
9399 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
9400 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
9401 something that can be ignored.
9402
9403 Example:
9404 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
9405 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
9406 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
9407 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
9408
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009409 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01009410 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009411
9412
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009413stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01009414 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009415 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9416 no | no | yes | yes
9417
9418 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009419 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009420 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009421 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009422 server is selected.
9423
9424 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9425 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9426 the "stick-table" statement.
9427
9428 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9429 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9430 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
9431 when the response is a SSL server hello.
9432
9433 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9434 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
9435 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
9436 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
9437 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
9438 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009439 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009440 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
9441 rules.
9442
9443 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9444 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9445 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9446 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9447 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9448 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9449 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9450
9451 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
9452 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9453 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
9454 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9455
9456 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
9457 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9458 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9459 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9460 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9461 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009462 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
9463 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9464 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9465 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9466 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9467 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
9468 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
9469 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
9470 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009471
9472 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
9473
9474 Example :
9475 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
9476 backend https
9477 mode tcp
9478 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009479 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009480 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009481
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009482 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
9483 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
9484
9485 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
9486 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9487 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
9488
9489 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
9490 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009491
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009492 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
9493 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
9494 # at offset 44.
9495
9496 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
9497 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
9498
9499 # Learn on response if server hello.
9500 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009501
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009502 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9503 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9504
9505 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
9506 extraction.
9507
9508
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009509tcp-check connect [params*]
9510 Opens a new connection
9511 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9512 no | no | yes | yes
9513
9514 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
9515 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
9516 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
9517
9518 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
9519 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
9520 of the sequence.
9521
9522 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
9523 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
9524 do.
9525
9526 Parameters :
9527 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
9528 use the TCP connection.
9529
9530 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
9531 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
9532 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
9533
9534 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
9535
9536 ssl opens a ciphered connection
9537
9538 Examples:
9539 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
9540 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
9541 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
9542 option tcp-check
9543 tcp-check connect
9544 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9545 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9546 tcp-check send \r\n
9547 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9548 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
9549 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9550 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9551 tcp-check send \r\n
9552 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9553 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
9554
9555 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
9556 option tcp-check
9557 tcp-check connect port 110
9558 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9559 tcp-check connect port 143
9560 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9561 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
9562
9563 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
9564
9565
9566tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009567 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009568 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9569 no | no | yes | yes
9570
9571 Arguments :
9572 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
9573 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
9574 binary.
9575 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
9576 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
9577 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
9578
9579 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
9580 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
9581 with the usual backslash ('\').
9582 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009583 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009584 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
9585 used upper or lower case.
9586
9587
9588 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
9589
9590 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
9591 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9592 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
9593 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9594 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
9595 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
9596 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
9597 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
9598
9599 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
9600 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9601 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
9602 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9603 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
9604 expression.
9605
9606 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
9607 in the response buffer. A health check response will
9608 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
9609 this exact hexadecimal string.
9610 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
9611
9612 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
9613 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
9614 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
9615 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
9616 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
9617 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
9618 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
9619 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
9620 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
9621 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
9622 the null character.
9623
9624 Examples :
9625 # perform a POP check
9626 option tcp-check
9627 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9628
9629 # perform an IMAP check
9630 option tcp-check
9631 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9632
9633 # look for the redis master server
9634 option tcp-check
9635 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009636 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009637 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9638 tcp-check expect string role:master
9639 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9640 tcp-check expect string +OK
9641
9642
9643 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
9644 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
9645
9646
9647tcp-check send <data>
9648 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9649 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9650 no | no | yes | yes
9651
9652 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9653 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
9654
9655 Examples :
9656 # look for the redis master server
9657 option tcp-check
9658 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9659 tcp-check expect string role:master
9660
9661 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9662 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
9663
9664
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009665tcp-check send-binary <hexstring>
9666 Specify a hex digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009667 tcp health check
9668 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9669 no | no | yes | yes
9670
9671 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9672 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009673 <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009674 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
9675 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
9676 hexadecimal string.
9677 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
9678
9679 Examples :
9680 # redis check in binary
9681 option tcp-check
9682 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
9683 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
9684
9685
9686 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9687 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
9688
9689
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009690tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9691 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009692 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9693 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009694 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009695 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9696 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009697
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009698 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009699
9700 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
9701 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009702 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
9703 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
9704 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
9705 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
9706 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
9707 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009708
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009709 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9710 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9711 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
9712 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009713
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009714 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009715 - accept :
9716 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9717 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9718 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009719
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009720 - reject :
9721 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9722 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9723 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
9724 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
9725 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
9726 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
9727 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
9728 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
9729 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
9730 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
9731 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009732 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009733
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009734 - expect-proxy layer4 :
9735 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
9736 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
9737 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
9738 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
9739 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
9740 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
9741 hosts.
9742
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01009743 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
9744 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
9745 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
9746 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
9747 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
9748 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
9749 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
9750 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
9751
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009752 - capture <sample> len <length> :
9753 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
9754 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
9755 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
9756 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
9757 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
9758 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
9759 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
9760 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009761 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
9762 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009763
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009764 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009765 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +02009766 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
9767 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
9768 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
9769 haproxy -vv) whichs defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
9770 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
9771 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
9772 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
9773 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
9774 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
9775 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
9776 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
9777 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009778
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009779 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009780 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009781 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009782 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009783 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
9784 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
9785 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009786
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009787 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
9788 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
9789 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
9790 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009791
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009792 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
9793 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
9794 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
9795 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
9796 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009797 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
9798 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
9799 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
9800 layer7 information is extracted.
9801
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009802 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
9803 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
9804 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
9805 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
9806 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009807
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009808 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9809 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9810 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9811 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9812
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009813 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
9814 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
9815 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9816 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9817
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009818 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>:
9819 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9820 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9821 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9822 continues.
9823
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009824 - set-src <expr> :
9825 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
9826 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
9827 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009828 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009829
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009830 Arguments:
9831 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9832 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009833
9834 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009835 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
9836
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009837 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
9838 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009839
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009840 - set-src-port <expr> :
9841 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
9842 expression.
9843
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009844 Arguments:
9845 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9846 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009847
9848 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009849 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
9850
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009851 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
9852 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
9853 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009854
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009855 - set-dst <expr> :
9856 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
9857 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
9858 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
9859 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9860 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9861
9862 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9863 followed by some converters.
9864
9865 Example:
9866
9867 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
9868 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
9869
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009870 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
9871 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
9872
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009873 - set-dst-port <expr> :
9874 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
9875 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9876 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9877
9878
9879 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9880 followed by some converters.
9881
9882 Example:
9883
9884 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
9885
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009886 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
9887 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
9888 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
9889
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009890 - "silent-drop" :
9891 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009892 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009893 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9894 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9895 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9896 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9897 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009898 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
9899 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009900 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9901 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009902 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009903 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9904 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9905 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9906 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9907
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009908 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9909 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9910 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009911
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009912 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9913 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
9914 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009915
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009916 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009917 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009918 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009919
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009920 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
9921 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9922 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009923
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009924 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009925 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9926 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009927
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009928 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
9929
9930 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9931
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009932 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9933
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009934 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009935
9936
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009937tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9938 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009939 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009940 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009941 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009942 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9943 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009944
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009945 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009946
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009947 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009948 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9949 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
9950 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
9951 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009952
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009953 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
9954 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
9955 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
9956 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009957 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
9958 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
9959 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
9960 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
9961 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
9962 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009963 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009964 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009965
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009966 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9967 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9968 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9969 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009970
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009971 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009972 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01009973 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009974 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9975 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04009976 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009977 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009978 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009979 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Thierry Fournierb9125672016-03-29 19:34:37 +02009980 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +02009981 - set-dst <expr>
9982 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009983 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009984 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009985 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009986 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009987
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009988 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
9989 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01009990 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
9991 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009992
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009993 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
9994 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
9995 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
9996 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
9997 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
9998 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009999
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010000 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010001 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10002 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010003
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010004 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020010005 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
10006 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
10007 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
10008 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010009 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
10010 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
10011 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010012
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010013 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010014 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
10015 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
10016 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010017
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020010018 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
10019 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
10020
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010021 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010022 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
10023 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010024
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010025 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10026 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010027 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010028 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10029 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010030 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010031 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010032 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010033 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10034 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010035 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010036 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10037 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010038
10039 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10040 followed by some converters.
10041
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010042 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10043 <var-name>.
10044
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040010045 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
10046 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
10047 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
10048 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
10049 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
10050
10051 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
10052 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
10053 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
10054 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
10055 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
10056 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
10057 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
10058 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
10059 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
10060 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
10061 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
10062
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010063 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10064 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10065 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10066 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10067 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10068
10069 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10070
10071 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10072
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010073 Example:
10074
10075 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010076 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010077
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010078 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010079 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
10080 # and reject everything else.
10081 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
10082 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020010083 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010084 tcp-request content reject
10085
10086 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010087 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
10088 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
10089 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010090 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010091
10092 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
10093 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
10094 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010095 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010096 tcp-request content reject
10097
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010098 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010099 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010100 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010101 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010102 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
10103 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010104
10105 Example:
10106 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
10107 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010108 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010109
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010110 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010111 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010112
10113 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010114 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010115 # protecting all our sites
10116 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010117 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
10118 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010119 ...
10120 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
10121
10122 backend http_dynamic
10123 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010124 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010125 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010126 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010127 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010128 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010129 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010130
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010131 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010132
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030010133 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
10134 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010135
10136
10137tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
10138 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
10139 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010140 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010141 Arguments :
10142 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10143 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10144 as explained at the top of this document.
10145
10146 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
10147 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
10148 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
10149 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
10150 data for at most the specified amount of time.
10151
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010152 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
10153 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
10154 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
10155 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
10156
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010157 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
10158 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010159 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010160 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010010161 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
10162 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
10163 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
10164 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010165
10166 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
10167 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
10168 it pass through unaffected.
10169
10170 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
10171 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
10172 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010173 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010174 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
10175 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020010176 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
10177 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
10178 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010179
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010180 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010181 "timeout client".
10182
10183
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010184tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10185 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
10186 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10187 no | no | yes | yes
10188 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010189 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10190 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010191
10192 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10193
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010194 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010195 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
10196 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010197 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
10198 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010199
10200 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
10201
10202 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
10203 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
10204 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
10205 inserted.
10206
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010207 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010208 - accept :
10209 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10210 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10211 the rules evaluation.
10212
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010213 - close :
10214 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
10215 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
10216 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
10217 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
10218 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
10219 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010220 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010221 protocols.
10222
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010223 - reject :
10224 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10225 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010226 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010227
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010228 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
10229 Sets a variable.
10230
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010231 - unset-var(<var-name>)
10232 Unsets a variable.
10233
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010234 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
10235 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
10236 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10237 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10238
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010239 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
10240 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10241 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10242 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10243
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010244 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
10245 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
10246 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
10247 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
10248 continues.
10249
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010250 - "silent-drop" :
10251 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010252 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010253 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10254 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10255 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10256 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10257 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010258 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10259 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010260 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10261 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010262 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010263 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10264 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10265 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10266 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10267
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010268 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
10269 Send a group of SPOE messages.
10270
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010271 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10272 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10273 for changing the default action to a reject.
10274
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010275 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
10276 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
10277 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
10278 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010279 period.
10280
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010281 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
10282 declared inline.
10283
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010284 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10285 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010286 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010287 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10288 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010289 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010290 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010291 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010292 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10293 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010294 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010295 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10296 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010297
10298 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10299 followed by some converters.
10300
10301 Example:
10302
10303 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
10304
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010305 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10306 <var-name>.
10307
10308 Example:
10309
10310 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
10311
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010312 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10313 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10314 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10315 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10316 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10317
10318 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10319
10320 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10321
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010322 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10323
10324 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
10325
10326
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010327tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10328 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
10329 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10330 no | yes | yes | no
10331 Arguments :
10332 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10333 below.
10334
10335 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10336
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010337 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010338 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
10339 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
10340 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
10341 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
10342 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
10343 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
10344 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010345 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010346 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
10347 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
10348 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
10349 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
10350 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
10351 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
10352 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
10353 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
10354 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
10355 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
10356 instead.
10357
10358 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10359 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10360 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
10361 rules which may be inserted.
10362
10363 Several types of actions are supported :
10364 - accept : the request is accepted
10365 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10366 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
10367 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010368 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010369 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
10370 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010371 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010372 - silent-drop
10373
10374 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
10375 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
10376 sections for a complete description.
10377
10378 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10379 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10380 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
10381
10382 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
10383 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
10384 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
10385 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
10386 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
10387
10388 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10389 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10390
10391 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10392 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
10393 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
10394
10395 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10396 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
10397 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10398
10399 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
10400 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10401 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
10402
10403 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10404 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10405 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
10406
10407 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10408
10409 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
10410
10411
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010412tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
10413 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
10414 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10415 no | no | yes | yes
10416 Arguments :
10417 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10418 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10419 as explained at the top of this document.
10420
10421 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
10422
10423
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010424timeout check <timeout>
10425 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
10426 established.
10427
10428 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10429 yes | no | yes | yes
10430 Arguments:
10431 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10432 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10433 as explained at the top of this document.
10434
10435 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
10436 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010437 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010438 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010010439 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
10440 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
10441 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010442
10443 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
10444 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
10445
10446 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
10447 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010448 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010449
10450 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10451 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10452 forget about it.
10453
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010454 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
10455 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010456
10457
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010458timeout client <timeout>
10459timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10460 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
10461 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10462 yes | yes | yes | no
10463 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010464 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010465 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10466 as explained at the top of this document.
10467
10468 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10469 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10470 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010471 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
10472 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
10473 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
10474 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010475 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
10476 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
10477 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010478 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010479 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010480 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
10481 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010482 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
10483 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010484
10485 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10486 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10487 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10488 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
10489 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
10490 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10491
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010492 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010493
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010494 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
10495 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
10496 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10497
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010498 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel",
10499 "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010500
10501
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010502timeout client-fin <timeout>
10503 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
10504 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10505 yes | yes | yes | no
10506 Arguments :
10507 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10508 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10509 as explained at the top of this document.
10510
10511 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10512 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10513 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10514 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10515 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
10516 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10517 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010010518 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
10519 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
10520 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010521
10522 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10523 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10524 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
10525
10526 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
10527
10528
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010529timeout connect <timeout>
10530timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10531 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
10532 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10533 yes | no | yes | yes
10534 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010535 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010536 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10537 as explained at the top of this document.
10538
10539 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010540 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010541 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010542 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010543 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
10544 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010545
10546 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10547 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10548 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10549 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
10550 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
10551 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10552
10553 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
10554 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
10555 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10556
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010557 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
10558 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010559
10560
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010561timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
10562 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
10563 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10564 yes | yes | yes | yes
10565 Arguments :
10566 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10567 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10568 as explained at the top of this document.
10569
10570 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
10571 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
10572 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
10573 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
10574 once the request has started to present itself.
10575
10576 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
10577 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
10578 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
10579 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
10580 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
10581
10582 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
10583 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
10584 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
10585 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
10586
10587 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
10588 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010589 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010590 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
10591 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020010592 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010593
10594 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
10595 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
10596 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
10597 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
10598
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010599 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
10600 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010601 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
10602
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010603 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
10604
10605
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010606timeout http-request <timeout>
10607 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
10608 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010609 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010610 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010611 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010612 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10613 as explained at the top of this document.
10614
10615 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
10616 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
10617 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
10618 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
10619 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
10620 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
10621 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020010622 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
10623 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
10624 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
10625 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010626 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010627 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
10628 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010629
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010630 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
10631 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
10632 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
10633 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
10634 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010635 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010636
10637 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
10638 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010639 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010640 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
10641 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
10642
10643 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010644 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
10645 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
10646 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010647
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010648 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010649 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010650
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010651
10652timeout queue <timeout>
10653 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
10654 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10655 yes | no | yes | yes
10656 Arguments :
10657 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10658 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10659 as explained at the top of this document.
10660
10661 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
10662 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
10663 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
10664 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
10665 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
10666
10667 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
10668 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
10669 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
10670 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
10671
10672 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
10673
10674
10675timeout server <timeout>
10676timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10677 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
10678 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10679 yes | no | yes | yes
10680 Arguments :
10681 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10682 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10683 as explained at the top of this document.
10684
10685 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10686 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10687 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
10688 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
10689 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
10690 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
10691 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
10692
10693 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10694 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10695 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
10696 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
10697 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010698 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010699 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010700 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
10701 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010702 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
10703 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010704
10705 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10706 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10707 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10708 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
10709 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
10710 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10711
10712 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
10713 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
10714 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10715
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010716 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010717
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010718
10719timeout server-fin <timeout>
10720 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
10721 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10722 yes | no | yes | yes
10723 Arguments :
10724 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10725 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10726 as explained at the top of this document.
10727
10728 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10729 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10730 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10731 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10732 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
10733 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10734 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
10735 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
10736 situations, it should not be needed.
10737
10738 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10739 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10740 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
10741
10742 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
10743
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010744
10745timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010746 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010747 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10748 yes | yes | yes | yes
10749 Arguments :
10750 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
10751 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10752 as explained at the top of this document.
10753
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010754 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit" or
10755 "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with no activity for a certain
10756 amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit" defines how long it will
10757 be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010758
10759 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10760 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10761 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
10762 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010763 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010764
10765 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
10766
10767
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010768timeout tunnel <timeout>
10769 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
10770 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10771 yes | no | yes | yes
10772 Arguments :
10773 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10774 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10775 as explained at the top of this document.
10776
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010777 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010778 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
10779 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
10780 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010781 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
10782 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010783 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
10784 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
10785 specified.
10786
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010787 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
10788 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
10789 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
10790 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
10791 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
10792 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
10793 state.
10794
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010795 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10796 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10797 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
10798 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010799 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010800
10801 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10802 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10803 forget about it.
10804
10805 Example :
10806 defaults http
10807 option http-server-close
10808 timeout connect 5s
10809 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010810 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010811 timeout server 30s
10812 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
10813
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010814 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010815
10816
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010817transparent (deprecated)
10818 Enable client-side transparent proxying
10819 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010010820 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010821 Arguments : none
10822
10823 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
10824 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
10825 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
10826 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
10827 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
10828 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
10829 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
10830 appropriate server.
10831
10832 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
10833
10834 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
10835 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
10836
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010837 See also: "option transparent"
10838
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010839unique-id-format <string>
10840 Generate a unique ID for each request.
10841 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10842 yes | yes | yes | no
10843 Arguments :
10844 <string> is a log-format string.
10845
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010846 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
10847 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
10848 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
10849 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010850
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010851 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
10852 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
10853 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
10854 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
10855 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
10856 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
10857 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
10858 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010859
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010860 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
10861 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010862
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010863 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010864
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010865 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010866
10867 will generate:
10868
10869 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10870
10871 See also: "unique-id-header"
10872
10873unique-id-header <name>
10874 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
10875 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10876 yes | yes | yes | no
10877 Arguments :
10878 <name> is the name of the header.
10879
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010880 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
10881 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010882
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010883 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010884
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010885 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010886 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
10887
10888 will generate:
10889
10890 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10891
10892 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010893
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010894use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010895 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010896 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10897 no | yes | yes | no
10898 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010899 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
10900 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010901
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010902 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
10903 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010904
10905 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
10906 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
10907 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010908 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010909 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010910 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
10911 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010912
10913 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
10914 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
10915 assign the backend.
10916
10917 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
10918 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10919 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
10920 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
10921 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
10922 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
10923
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010924 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010925 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010926 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
10927 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
10928 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
10929
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010930 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
10931 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
10932 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
10933 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
10934 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
10935 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
10936 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
10937 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
10938 cannot be forced from the request.
10939
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010940 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010941 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
10942 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
10943
10944 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
10945 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010946
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010947
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010948use-server <server> if <condition>
10949use-server <server> unless <condition>
10950 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
10951 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10952 no | no | yes | yes
10953 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010954 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010955
10956 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
10957
10958 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
10959 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
10960 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
10961
10962 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
10963 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
10964 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
10965 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
10966 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
10967 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
10968 matches will assign the server.
10969
10970 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
10971 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
10972 with the next rules until one matches.
10973
10974 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
10975 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10976 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
10977 according to other persistence mechanisms.
10978
10979 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
10980 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
10981 stripped.
10982
10983 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
10984 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
10985 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
10986 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
10987
10988 Example :
10989 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
10990 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
10991 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
10992 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
10993 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
10994 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000010995 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010996 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
10997 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
10998
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010999 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011000
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011001
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100110025. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011003--------------------------
11004
11005The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
11006depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
11007settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
11008written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
11009described in this section.
11010
11011
110125.1. Bind options
11013-----------------
11014
11015The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
11016as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
11017no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
11018parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
11019while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
11020provided immediately after the setting name.
11021
11022The currently supported settings are the following ones.
11023
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011024accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
11025 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
11026 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
11027 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
11028 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
11029 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
11030 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
11031 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
11032 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
11033 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010011034 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
11035 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
11036 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011037
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011038accept-proxy
11039 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020011040 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
11041 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011042 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
11043 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
11044 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
11045 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011046 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011047 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
11048 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011049 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
11050 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011051
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020011052allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010011053 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010011054 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
11055 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, ie requests
11056 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
11057 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020011058
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011059alpn <protocols>
11060 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
11061 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
11062 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
11063 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
11064 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011065 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
11066 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
11067 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
11068 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
11069 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
11070 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
11071 preference, like below :
11072
11073 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011074
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011075backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010011076 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011077 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
11078
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010011079curves <curves>
11080 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
11081 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
11082 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
11083 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
11084 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
11085 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
11086
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020011087ecdhe <named curve>
11088 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010011089 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
11090 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020011091
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011092ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011093 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11094 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11095 client's certificate.
11096
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011097ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
11098 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11099 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
11100 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
11101 error is ignored.
11102
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011103ca-sign-file <cafile>
11104 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11105 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
11106 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
11107 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
11108 'generate-certificates' for details.
11109
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000011110ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011111 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
11112 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
11113 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
11114 'generate-certificates' for details.
11115
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011116ciphers <ciphers>
11117 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
11118 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000011119 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011120 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011121 information and recommendations see e.g.
11122 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
11123 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
11124 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
11125
11126ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
11127 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
11128 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
11129 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
11130 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011131 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
11132 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011133
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011134crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011135 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11136 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11137 to verify client's certificate.
11138
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011139crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011140 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11141 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
11142 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
11143 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
11144 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
11145 file.
11146
11147 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
11148 are loaded.
11149
11150 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010011151 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011152 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
11153 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
11154 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
11155 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011156 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
11157 instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011158 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011159
11160 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
11161 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
11162 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
11163 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010011164 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
11165 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011166
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020011167 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011168
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011169 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011170 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011171 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
11172 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011173 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
11174 clients).
11175
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020011176 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
11177 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
11178 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
11179 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
11180 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
11181 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
11182 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
11183 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
11184 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
11185 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
11186 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
11187 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
11188 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
11189
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011190 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
11191 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
11192 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
11193 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
11194 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
11195
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011196 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
11197 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
11198 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
11199 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011200
11201 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
11202 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
11203 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
11204 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
11205 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
11206 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
11207 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
11208 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
11209 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
11210
11211 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
11212
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011213 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011214 a cert bundle.
11215
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011216 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011217 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
11218 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
11219 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
11220 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
11221 provide multi-cert support.
11222
11223 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
11224
11225 Filename | CN | SAN
11226 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11227 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011228 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011229 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
11230 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11231
11232 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
11233 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
11234 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
11235 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011236 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
11237 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
11238 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011239
11240 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
11241 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
11242
11243 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
11244 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
11245 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
11246
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011247crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011248 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011249 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011250 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011251 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011252
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011253crt-list <file>
11254 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011255 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
11256 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011257
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011258 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
11259
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011260 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca-file", "no-ca-names",
11261 crl-file", "ecdhe", "curves", "ciphers" configuration. With BoringSSL
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011262 and Openssl >= 1.1.1 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported.
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011263 It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011264
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020011265 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
11266 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
11267 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
11268 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
11269 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
11270 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
11271 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
11272 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011273
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011274 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020011275 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011276 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
11277 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
11278 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011279
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011280 crt-list file example:
11281 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011282 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011283 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011284 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011285
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011286defer-accept
11287 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11288 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
11289 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011290 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011291 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
11292 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
11293 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
11294 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
11295 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
11296 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
11297 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
11298
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011299expose-fd listeners
11300 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
11301 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020011302 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
11303 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011304 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011305
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011306force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011307 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011308 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011309 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011310 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011311
11312force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011313 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011314 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011315 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011316
11317force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011318 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011319 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011320 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011321
11322force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011323 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011324 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011325 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011326
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011327force-tlsv13
11328 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
11329 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011330 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011331
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011332generate-certificates
11333 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11334 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
11335 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
11336 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
11337 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
11338 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
11339 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
11340 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
11341 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
11342 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
11343 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
11344
11345 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
11346 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011347 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011348 certificate is used many times.
11349
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011350gid <gid>
11351 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
11352 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11353 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
11354 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
11355 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11356
11357group <group>
11358 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
11359 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
11360 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
11361 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
11362 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11363
11364id <id>
11365 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
11366 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
11367 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
11368 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
11369
11370interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010011371 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
11372 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
11373 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
11374 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
11375 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
11376 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010011377 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
11378 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
11379 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
11380 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
11381 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
11382 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011383
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011384level <level>
11385 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
11386 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
11387 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011388 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011389 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
11390 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
11391 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011392 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011393 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011394 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011395 all counters).
11396
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020011397severity-output <format>
11398 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
11399 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
11400 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
11401 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
11402 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
11403 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
11404 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
11405 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
11406 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
11407 rfc5424 convention.
11408
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011409maxconn <maxconn>
11410 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
11411 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
11412 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
11413 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
11414 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
11415 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
11416 eat all memory.
11417
11418mode <mode>
11419 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
11420 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
11421 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
11422 UNIX sockets.
11423
11424mss <maxseg>
11425 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
11426 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
11427 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
11428 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
11429 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
11430 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
11431 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
11432 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
11433 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
11434 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
11435 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
11436
11437name <name>
11438 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
11439 page.
11440
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011441namespace <name>
11442 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11443 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
11444 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11445 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11446
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011447nice <nice>
11448 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
11449 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
11450 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
11451 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
11452 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
11453 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
11454 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
11455 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
11456 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
11457 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
11458 one for an RDP socket.
11459
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011460no-ca-names
11461 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11462 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
11463
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011464no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011465 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011466 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011467 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011468 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011469 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
11470 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011471
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011472no-tls-tickets
11473 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11474 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11475 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011476 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
11477 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011478
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011479no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011480 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011481 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011482 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011483 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011484 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11485 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011486
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011487no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011488 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011489 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011490 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011491 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011492 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11493 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011494
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011495no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011496 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011497 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011498 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011499 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011500 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11501 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011502
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011503no-tlsv13
11504 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11505 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
11506 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
11507 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011508 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11509 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011510
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011511npn <protocols>
11512 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11513 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11514 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11515 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011516 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011517 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
11518 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
11519 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
11520 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
11521 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011522
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011523prefer-client-ciphers
11524 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
11525 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
11526 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020011527 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
11528 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
11529 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011530
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011531process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011532 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011533 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011534 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011535 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
11536 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
11537 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
11538 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011539 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011540 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
11541 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
11542 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
11543 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
11544 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011545
11546 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
11547
11548 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
11549 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
11550 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
11551 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
11552 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
11553 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
11554 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
11555 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020011556
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011557proto <name>
11558 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
11559 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
11560 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
11561 in haproxy -vv.
11562 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
11563 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080011564 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011565 h2" on the bind line.
11566
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011567ssl
11568 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011569 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011570 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
11571 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020011572 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
11573 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011574
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011575ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11576 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
11577 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11578 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
11579
11580ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11581 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
11582 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11583 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
11584
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010011585strict-sni
11586 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
11587 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
11588 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
11589 See the "crt" option for more information.
11590
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011591tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011592 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011593 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
11594 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011595 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011596 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
11597 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
11598 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
11599 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
11600 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
11601 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
11602 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11603
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011604tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010011605 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011606 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
11607 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
11608 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
11609 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
11610 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
11611 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
11612 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020011613 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
11614 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
11615 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011616
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011617tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
11618 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010011619 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
11620 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
11621 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
11622 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
11623 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
11624 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
11625 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
11626 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
11627 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
11628 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011629 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
11630 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
11631
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011632transparent
11633 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11634 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
11635 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
11636 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
11637 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
11638 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
11639 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
11640 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
11641 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
11642 so check for support with your vendor.
11643
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011644v4v6
11645 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11646 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
11647 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
11648 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011649 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011650
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011651v6only
11652 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11653 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
11654 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011655 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
11656 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011657
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011658uid <uid>
11659 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
11660 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11661 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
11662 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
11663 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11664
11665user <user>
11666 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
11667 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11668 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
11669 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
11670 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11671
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011672verify [none|optional|required]
11673 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
11674 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
11675 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
11676 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
11677 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011678 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
11679 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
11680 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
11681 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011682
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200116835.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010011684------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011685
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011686The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
11687which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
11688arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
11689settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
11690after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
11691Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
11692address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011693
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011694 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011695 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011696
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011697Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
11698keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
11699
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011700The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011701
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020011702addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011703 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010011704 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
11705 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
11706 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
11707 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
11708 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011709
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011710agent-check
11711 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011712 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010011713 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
11714 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
11715 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011716
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011717 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011718 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020011719 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
11720 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
11721 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011722
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011723 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
11724 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
11725 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
11726 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
11727 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020011728
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011729 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011730 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011731
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011732 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11733 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
11734 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011735
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011736 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11737 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
11738 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011739
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011740 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
11741 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
11742 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
11743 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
11744 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011745 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011746 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011747
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011748 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
11749 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011750
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011751 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
11752 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
11753 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
11754 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
11755 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
11756 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
11757 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
11758 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
11759 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011760
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011761 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
11762 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011763 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
11764 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
11765 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010011766 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011767
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011768 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011769 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011770
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070011771agent-send <string>
11772 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
11773 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
11774 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
11775 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
11776 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
11777
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011778agent-inter <delay>
11779 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
11780 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11781
11782 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
11783 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
11784 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
11785 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
11786 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11787 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11788 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11789 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11790 of backends use the same servers.
11791
11792 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
11793
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010011794agent-addr <addr>
11795 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
11796
11797 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
11798 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
11799 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
11800 hostname, it will be resolved.
11801
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011802agent-port <port>
11803 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
11804
11805 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
11806
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020011807allow-0rtt
11808 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020011809 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
11810 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020011811
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011812alpn <protocols>
11813 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
11814 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
11815 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
11816 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
11817 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
11818 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
11819 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
11820 now obsolete NPN extension.
11821 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
11822 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
11823
11824 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
11825
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011826backup
11827 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
11828 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
11829 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
11830 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011831 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
11832 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011833
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011834ca-file <cafile>
11835 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11836 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11837 server's certificate.
11838
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011839check
11840 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010011841 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
11842 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
11843 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
11844 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
11845 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
11846 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
11847 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090011848 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
11849 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011850 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
11851 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011852
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020011853check-send-proxy
11854 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
11855 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
11856 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
11857 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
11858 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
11859 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
11860 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
11861
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010011862check-alpn <protocols>
11863 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
11864 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
11865 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11866
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010011867check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011868 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010011869 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
11870 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011871
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011872check-ssl
11873 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
11874 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
11875 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
11876 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011877 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011878 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
11879 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011880 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011881 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
11882 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011883
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011884ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011885 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
11886 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
11887 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011888 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
11889 information and recommendations see e.g.
11890 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
11891 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
11892 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011893
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011894ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
11895 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
11896 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
11897 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
11898 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011899 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
11900 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
11901 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011902
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011903cookie <value>
11904 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
11905 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
11906 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
11907 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
11908 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
11909 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
11910 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
11911
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011912crl-file <crlfile>
11913 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11914 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11915 to verify server's certificate.
11916
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020011917crt <cert>
11918 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11919 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
11920 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
11921 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
11922 certificate request.
11923
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011924disabled
11925 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
11926 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
11927 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
11928 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
11929 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011930 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011931
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011932enabled
11933 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
11934 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
11935 default value.
11936 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
11937 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011938
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011939error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010011940 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
11941 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
11942 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011943
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011944 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011945
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011946fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011947 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
11948 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
11949 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
11950
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011951force-sslv3
11952 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11953 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011954 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011955 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011956
11957force-tlsv10
11958 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011959 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011960 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011961
11962force-tlsv11
11963 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011964 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011965 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011966
11967force-tlsv12
11968 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011969 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011970 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011971
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011972force-tlsv13
11973 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11974 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011975 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011976
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011977id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020011978 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
11979 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
11980 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011981
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011982init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
11983 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
11984 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011985 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011986 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
11987 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
11988 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
11989 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
11990 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
11991 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
11992 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
11993 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
11994 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011995 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011996 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
11997 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
11998 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
11999 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
12000 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
12001 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012002 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012003
12004 Example:
12005 defaults
12006 # never fail on address resolution
12007 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
12008
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012009inter <delay>
12010fastinter <delay>
12011downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012012 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
12013 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
12014 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
12015 between checks depending on the server state :
12016
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020012017 Server state | Interval used
12018 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12019 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
12020 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12021 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
12022 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
12023 or yet unchecked. |
12024 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12025 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
12026 | "inter" otherwise.
12027 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012028
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012029 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
12030 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
12031 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
12032 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012033 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
12034 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
12035 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
12036 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
12037 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012038
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012039maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012040 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
12041 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
12042 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
12043 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
12044 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
12045 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
12046 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
12047 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
12048
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012049maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012050 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
12051 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
12052 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
12053 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
12054 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
12055 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
12056 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
12057
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010012058max-reuse <count>
12059 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
12060 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
12061 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
12062 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
12063 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
12064 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
12065 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
12066 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
12067
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012068minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012069 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
12070 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
12071 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
12072 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
12073 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
12074 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012075 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012076 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012077
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020012078namespace <name>
12079 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
12080 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
12081 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
12082 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
12083
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012084no-agent-check
12085 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
12086 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12087 default value.
12088 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12089 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
12090
12091no-backup
12092 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
12093 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12094 default value.
12095 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12096 "default-server" "backup" setting.
12097
12098no-check
12099 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
12100 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12101 default value.
12102 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12103 "default-server" "check" setting.
12104
12105no-check-ssl
12106 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
12107 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12108 default value.
12109 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12110 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
12111
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012112no-send-proxy
12113 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
12114 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12115 default value.
12116 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12117 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
12118
12119no-send-proxy-v2
12120 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
12121 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12122 default value.
12123 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12124 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
12125
12126no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
12127 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
12128 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12129 default value.
12130 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12131 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
12132
12133no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12134 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
12135 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12136 default value.
12137 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12138 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
12139
12140no-ssl
12141 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
12142 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12143 default value.
12144 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12145 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
12146
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010012147no-ssl-reuse
12148 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
12149 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
12150 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
12151 and for paranoid users.
12152
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012153no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012154 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
12155 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012156 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012157
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012158 Supported in default-server: No
12159
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020012160no-tls-tickets
12161 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12162 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
12163 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012164 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
12165 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012166 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020012167
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012168no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012169 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012170 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12171 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012172 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12173 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012174 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012175
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012176 Supported in default-server: No
12177
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012178no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012179 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012180 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12181 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012182 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12183 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012184 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012185
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012186 Supported in default-server: No
12187
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012188no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012189 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012190 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12191 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012192 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12193 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012194 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012195
12196 Supported in default-server: No
12197
12198no-tlsv13
12199 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
12200 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12201 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
12202 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12203 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012204 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012205
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012206 Supported in default-server: No
12207
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012208no-verifyhost
12209 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
12210 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12211 default value.
12212 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12213 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012214
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090012215non-stick
12216 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
12217 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
12218 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
12219
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012220npn <protocols>
12221 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
12222 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
12223 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
12224 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
12225 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
12226 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
12227 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
12228
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012229observe <mode>
12230 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
12231 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
12232 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
12233 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
12234 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
12235 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010012236 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012237
12238 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
12239
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012240on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012241 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
12242 Currently, four modes are available:
12243 - fastinter: force fastinter
12244 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
12245 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
12246 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
12247 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
12248
12249 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
12250
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012251on-marked-down <action>
12252 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
12253 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012254 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
12255 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
12256 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
12257 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
12258 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
12259 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
12260 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
12261 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012262
12263 Actions are disabled by default
12264
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012265on-marked-up <action>
12266 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
12267 Currently one action is available:
12268 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
12269 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
12270 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
12271 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012272 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
12273 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012274 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
12275 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
12276
12277 Actions are disabled by default
12278
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010012279pool-max-conn <max>
12280 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
12281 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
12282 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
12283 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
12284 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
12285 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
12286
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012287pool-purge-delay <delay>
12288 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010012289 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
12290 The default is 1s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012291
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012292port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012293 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
12294 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
12295 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
12296 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
12297 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
12298 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
12299
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020012300proto <name>
12301
12302 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
12303 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
12304 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
12305 reported in haproxy -vv.
12306 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
12307 protocol for all connections established to this server.
12308
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012309redir <prefix>
12310 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
12311 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
12312 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
12313 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
12314 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
12315 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
12316 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
12317 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012318 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012319 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012320 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
12321 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
12322 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
12323 loop between the client and HAProxy!
12324
12325 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
12326
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012327rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012328 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
12329 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
12330 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
12331
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020012332resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
12333 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
12334 server.
12335
12336 Available options:
12337
12338 * allow-dup-ip
12339 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
12340 resolution at runtime is in operation.
12341 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
12342 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
12343 For such case, simply enable this option.
12344 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
12345
12346 * prevent-dup-ip
12347 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
12348 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
12349 same fqdn.
12350 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
12351
12352 Example:
12353 backend b_myapp
12354 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
12355 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12356 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12357
12358 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
12359 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
12360 it
12361 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
12362 different address
12363
12364 Default value: not set
12365
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012366resolve-prefer <family>
12367 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
12368 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
12369 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
12370 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
12371
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020012372 Default value: ipv6
12373
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012374 Example:
12375
12376 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012377
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012378resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
12379 This options prioritize th choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
12380 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012381 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012382 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
12383 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012384 configured network, another address is selected.
12385
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012386 Example:
12387
12388 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012389
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012390resolvers <id>
12391 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
12392 hostname.
12393
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012394 Example:
12395
12396 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012397
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012398 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012399
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012400send-proxy
12401 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
12402 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
12403 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
12404 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012405 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
12406 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
12407 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
12408 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
12409 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
12410 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
12411 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
12412 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
12413 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
12414 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012415 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
12416 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012417
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012418send-proxy-v2
12419 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
12420 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12421 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12422 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020012423 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
12424 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
12425 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
12426 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012427
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012428proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
12429 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add option to send in PROXY protocol version
12430 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are "ssl" (see also
Emmanuel Hocdetfa8d0f12018-02-01 15:53:52 +010012431 send-proxy-v2-ssl), "cert-cn" (see also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"), "ssl-cipher":
12432 name of the used cipher, "cert-sig": signature algorithm of the used
Emmanuel Hocdet253c3b72018-02-01 18:29:59 +010012433 certificate, "cert-key": key algorithm of the used certificate), "authority":
12434 host name value passed by the client (only sni from a tls connection is
Emmanuel Hocdet4399c752018-02-05 15:26:43 +010012435 supported), "crc32c": checksum of the proxy protocol v2 header.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012436
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012437send-proxy-v2-ssl
12438 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12439 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12440 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12441 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12442 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12443 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
12444 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012445 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
12446 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012447
12448send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12449 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12450 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12451 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12452 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12453 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12454 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
12455 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
12456 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012457 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
12458 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012459
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012460slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012461 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
12462 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
12463 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
12464 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
12465 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
12466 parameters :
12467
12468 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
12469 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
12470
12471 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
12472 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
12473 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
12474 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
12475
12476 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
12477 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
12478 seen as failed.
12479
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012480sni <expression>
12481 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
12482 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
12483 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
12484 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020012485 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
12486 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012487 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010012488 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
12489 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012490
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012491source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020012492source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012493source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012494 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
12495 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
12496 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
12497 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
12498
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012499 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
12500 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
12501 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
12502 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
12503 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
12504 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
12505 server.
12506
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000012507 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
12508 specifying the source address without port(s).
12509
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012510ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020012511 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
12512 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
12513 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
12514 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
12515 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
12516 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012517 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
12518 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012519
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012520ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12521 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
12522 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12523 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12524
12525ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12526 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
12527 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12528 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
12529
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012530ssl-reuse
12531 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
12532 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12533 default value.
12534 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12535 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
12536
12537stick
12538 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
12539 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12540 default value.
12541 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12542 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012543
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012544tcp-ut <delay>
12545 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
12546 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
12547 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012548 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012549 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
12550 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
12551 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
12552 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
12553 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
12554 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
12555 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
12556 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
12557 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12558
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010012559tfo
12560 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
12561 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
12562 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
12563 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
12564 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
12565 won't be able to retry the connection on failure.
12566
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012567track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020012568 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
12569 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
12570 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
12571 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012572 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
12573
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012574tls-tickets
12575 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
12576 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12577 default value.
12578 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12579 "default-server" "no-tlsv-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012580
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012581verify [none|required]
12582 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010012583 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012584 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
12585 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012586 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012587 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
12588 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
12589 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
12590 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
12591 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
12592 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
12593 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
12594 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012595
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012596verifyhost <hostname>
12597 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012598 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
12599 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
12600 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
12601 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
12602 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
12603 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
12604 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
12605 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012606
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012607weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012608 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
12609 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
12610 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020012611 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
12612 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
12613 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
12614 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
12615 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
12616 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012617
12618
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200126195.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
12620-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012621
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012622HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
12623using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
12624configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012625This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
12626can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
12627workload.
12628This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
12629resolution at run time.
12630Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
12631carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
12632
12633
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200126345.3.1. Global overview
12635----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012636
12637As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
12638different steps of the process life:
12639
12640 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
12641 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
12642 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
12643
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012644 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
12645 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012646
12647A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
12648 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
12649 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
12650 resolution to know this new IP.
12651
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012652When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012653HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012654SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
12655from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
12656will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
12657will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020012658
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012659A few things important to notice:
12660 - all the name servers are queried in the mean time. HAProxy will process the
12661 first valid response.
12662
12663 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
12664 servers return an error.
12665
12666
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200126675.3.2. The resolvers section
12668----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012669
12670This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012671HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
12672contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012673
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012674When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
12675uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
12676is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
12677answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
12678
12679When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012680used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012681
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012682 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
12683 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
12684 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012685
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012686 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
12687 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012688
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012689 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
12690 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
12691 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012692
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012693For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
12694following scenarios are possible:
12695
12696 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
12697 ignored
12698
12699 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
12700 applied
12701
12702 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
12703 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
12704
12705 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
12706 retries the query with a new type
12707
12708 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
12709 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012710
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012711As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
12712a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012713<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012714
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012715
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012716resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012717 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012718
12719A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
12720
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012721accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012722 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012723 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012724 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
12725 by RFC 6891)
12726
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020012727 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
12728
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012729nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
12730 DNS server description:
12731 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
12732 <ip> : IP address of the server
12733 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
12734
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012735parse-resolv-conf
12736 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
12737 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
12738 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
12739
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012740hold <status> <period>
12741 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
12742 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012743 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012744 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012745 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
12746 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12747 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
12748
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020012749 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012750
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012751resolution_pool_size <nb> (deprecated)
Baptiste Assmann201c07f2017-05-22 15:17:15 +020012752 Defines the number of resolutions available in the pool for this resolvers.
12753 If not defines, it defaults to 64. If your configuration requires more than
12754 <nb>, then HAProxy will return an error when parsing the configuration.
12755
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012756resolve_retries <nb>
12757 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
12758 giving up.
12759 Default value: 3
12760
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012761 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
12762 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
12763 type.
12764
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012765timeout <event> <time>
12766 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
12767 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
12768 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010012769 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
12770 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012771 Default value: 1s
12772 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010012773 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012774 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012775 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12776 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
12777
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012778 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012779
12780 resolvers mydns
12781 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
12782 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012783 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012784 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012785 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012786 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012787 hold other 30s
12788 hold refused 30s
12789 hold nx 30s
12790 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012791 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012792 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012793
12794
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200127956. HTTP header manipulation
12796---------------------------
12797
12798In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
12799response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
12800request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
12801which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010012802against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012803
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010012804If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
12805to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
12806but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
12807HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
12808stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
12809because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
12810a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
12811still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020012812
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012813This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
12814in section 4.2 :
12815
12816 - reqadd <string>
12817 - reqallow <search>
12818 - reqiallow <search>
12819 - reqdel <search>
12820 - reqidel <search>
12821 - reqdeny <search>
12822 - reqideny <search>
12823 - reqpass <search>
12824 - reqipass <search>
12825 - reqrep <search> <replace>
12826 - reqirep <search> <replace>
12827 - reqtarpit <search>
12828 - reqitarpit <search>
12829 - rspadd <string>
12830 - rspdel <search>
12831 - rspidel <search>
12832 - rspdeny <search>
12833 - rspideny <search>
12834 - rsprep <search> <replace>
12835 - rspirep <search> <replace>
12836
12837With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
12838is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
12839parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
12840prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
12841Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
12842
12843 \t for a tab
12844 \r for a carriage return (CR)
12845 \n for a new line (LF)
12846 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
12847 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
12848 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
12849 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
12850 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
12851
12852The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
12853portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
12854above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
12855regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
128569 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
12857is very common to users of the "sed" program.
12858
12859The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
12860after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
12861
12862Notes related to these keywords :
12863---------------------------------
12864 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
12865 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
12866 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
12867
12868 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
12869 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
12870 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
12871
12872 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
12873 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
12874 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
12875 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
12876 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
12877
12878 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
12879 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
12880 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
12881 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
12882 useless headers before adding new ones.
12883
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012884 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012885 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
12886
12887 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
12888 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
12889 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
12890
12891 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
12892 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012893 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012894
12895
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200128967. Using ACLs and fetching samples
12897----------------------------------
12898
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012899HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012900client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
12901The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
12902these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
12903but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
12904data called patterns.
12905
12906
129077.1. ACL basics
12908---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012909
12910The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
12911content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
12912from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
12913simple :
12914
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012915 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012916 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012917 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
12918 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012919
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012920The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
12921adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012922
12923In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
12924
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012925 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012926
12927This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
12928Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
12929and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012930an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
12931conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
12932as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
12933are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012934
12935ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
12936'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
12937which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
12938
12939There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
12940performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
12941
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012942The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
12943specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
12944this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012945methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
12946ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012947
12948Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
12949 - boolean
12950 - integer (signed or unsigned)
12951 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
12952 - string
12953 - data block
12954
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012955Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
12956converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
12957would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
12958The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
12959which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
12960
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012961Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
12962keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
12963fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
12964which are summarized in the table below :
12965
12966 +---------------------+-----------------+
12967 | Sample or converter | Default |
12968 | output type | matching method |
12969 +---------------------+-----------------+
12970 | boolean | bool |
12971 +---------------------+-----------------+
12972 | integer | int |
12973 +---------------------+-----------------+
12974 | ip | ip |
12975 +---------------------+-----------------+
12976 | string | str |
12977 +---------------------+-----------------+
12978 | binary | none, use "-m" |
12979 +---------------------+-----------------+
12980
12981Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
12982matching method, see below.
12983
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012984The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
12985 - boolean
12986 - integer or integer range
12987 - IP address / network
12988 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
12989 - regular expression
12990 - hex block
12991
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012992The following ACL flags are currently supported :
12993
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012994 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
12995 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012996 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012997 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012998 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012999 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013000 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
13001
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013002The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
13003read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
13004if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
13005lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
13006will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
13007beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
13008a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
13009lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
13010exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
13011
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010013012The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
13013parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
13014ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
13015a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
13016check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
13017
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010013018The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
13019socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
13020file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
13021
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013022Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
13023loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
13024
13025 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
13026
13027In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
13028the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
13029case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
13030as well.
13031
13032The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
13033sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
13034do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
13035methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
13036is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013037obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013038followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
13039default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
13040that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
13041string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
13042
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013043The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
13044By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
13045string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
13046resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
13047server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
13048waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
13049flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
13050function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
13051
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013052There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
13053sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
13054be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013055
13056 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
13057 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013058 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
13059 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
13060 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
13061 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013062
13063 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
13064 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013065 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013066
13067 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013068 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013069
13070 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013071 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013072
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013073 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013074 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
13075
13076 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
13077 binary or string samples.
13078
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013079 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
13080 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013081
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013082 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
13083 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
13084 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013085
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013086 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
13087 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013088
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013089 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
13090 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013091
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013092 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
13093 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013094
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013095 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
13096 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013097 This may be used with binary or string samples.
13098
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013099 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
13100 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
13101 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013102
13103For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
13104request, it is possible to do :
13105
13106 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
13107
13108In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
13109buffer, one would use the following acl :
13110
13111 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
13112
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013113On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
13114possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
13115
13116 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
13117
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013118All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
13119criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
13120method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
13121to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
13122criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
13123the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013124
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013125If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013126the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
13127For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013128
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013129 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
13130 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
13131 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
13132 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013133
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013134
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013135The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
13136types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
13137combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
13138brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
13139default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013140
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013141 +-------------------------------------------------+
13142 | Input sample type |
13143 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013144 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013145 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
13146 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
13147 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013148 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013149 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013150 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013151 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013152 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013153 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013154 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013155 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013156 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013157 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013158 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013159 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013160 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013161 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013162 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013163 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013164 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013165 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013166 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013167 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013168 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013169 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
13170 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
13171 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013172
13173
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200131747.1.1. Matching booleans
13175------------------------
13176
13177In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
13178Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
13179When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
13180that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
13181
13182Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
13183return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
13184"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
13185
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013186
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200131877.1.2. Matching integers
13188------------------------
13189
13190Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
13191enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
13192to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
13193
13194Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
13195matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
13196lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013197
13198For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
13199unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
13200representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
13201
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013202As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
13203two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
13204instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
13205ranges and operators.
13206
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013207For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013208operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
13209Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
13210of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013211
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013212Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013213
13214 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
13215 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
13216 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
13217 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
13218 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
13219
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013220For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013221
13222 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
13223
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013224This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
13225
13226 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
13227
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013228
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200132297.1.3. Matching strings
13230-----------------------
13231
13232String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
13233different forms :
13234
13235 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013236 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013237
13238 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013239 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013240
13241 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
13242 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13243
13244 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
13245 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13246
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010013247 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013248 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
13249 matches.
13250
13251 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
13252 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
13253 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013254
13255String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
13256exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
13257characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
13258string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
13259to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013260before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013261
13262
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200132637.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
13264---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013265
13266Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
13267they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
13268possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
13269passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
13270the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013271the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
13272match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013273
13274
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200132757.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
13276-------------------------------------
13277
13278It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
13279not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
13280a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
13281to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
13282digits may be used upper or lower case.
13283
13284Example :
13285 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
13286 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
13287
13288
132897.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
13290---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013291
13292IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
13293netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
13294within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013295host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013296difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
13297at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
13298does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
13299parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013300
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020013301The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
13302abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
13303
13304 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13305 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
13306 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13307 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
13308 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
13309 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
13310 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
13311 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13312
13313Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
13314192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
13315
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013316IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
13317Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
13318trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
13319IPv6 patterns.
13320
13321HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
13322following situations :
13323 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
13324 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
13325 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
13326 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
13327 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
13328 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
13329 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
13330 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
13331 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
13332 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
13333
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013334
133357.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
13336----------------------------------
13337
13338Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
13339combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
13340
13341 - AND (implicit)
13342 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
13343 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013344
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013345A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013346
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013347 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013348
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013349Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
13350indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013351
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013352For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
13353"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
13354requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
13355is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
13356
13357 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013358 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
13359 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
13360 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013361
13362To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
13363and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
13364
13365 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
13366 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
13367 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
13368 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
13369
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013370 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013371 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
13372 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
13373 use_backend www if host_www
13374
13375It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
13376expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
13377be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
13378the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
13379
13380 The following rule :
13381
13382 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013383 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013384
13385 Can also be written that way :
13386
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013387 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013388
13389It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
13390to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
13391simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
13392sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
13393good use is the following :
13394
13395 With named ACLs :
13396
13397 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
13398 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
13399 monitor fail if site_dead
13400
13401 With anonymous ACLs :
13402
13403 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
13404
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013405See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
13406keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013407
13408
134097.3. Fetching samples
13410---------------------
13411
13412Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
13413against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
13414sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
13415ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
13416of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
13417available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
13418
13419This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
13420Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
13421compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
13422deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
13423
13424The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
13425matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
13426method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
13427indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
13428
13429As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
13430when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
13431mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
13432the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
13433ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
13434
13435Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
13436multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
13437when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013438incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
13439are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013440is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
13441all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
13442
13443Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
13444 - name
13445 - name(arg1)
13446 - name(arg1,arg2)
13447
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013448
134497.3.1. Converters
13450-----------------
13451
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013452Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
13453of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
13454is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
13455was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013456has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013457unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
13458
13459These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
13460sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
13461the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013462support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013463
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013464A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
13465support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
13466supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
13467(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
13468bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
13469
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013470The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013471
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001347251d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
13473 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
13474 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
13475 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
13476 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
13477 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
13478
13479 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013480 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
13481 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000013482 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
13483 frontend http-in
13484 bind *:8081
13485 default_backend servers
13486 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
13487 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
13488
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013489add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013490 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013491 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013492 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
13493 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013494 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013495 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13496 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13497 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13498 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013499 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013500 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013501
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010013502aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
13503 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
13504 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
13505 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
13506 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
13507 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
13508 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
13509
13510 Example:
13511 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
13512 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
13513
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013514and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013515 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013516 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013517 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13518 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013519 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013520 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13521 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13522 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13523 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013524 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013525 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013526
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020013527b64dec
13528 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
13529 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
13530
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013531base64
13532 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013533 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013534 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
13535
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013536bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013537 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013538 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013539 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013540 presence of a flag).
13541
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013542bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
13543 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
13544 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013545 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013546
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013547concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
13548 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
13549 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
13550 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
13551 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
13552 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
13553 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
13554 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
13555 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
13556 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
13557 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
13558 other variables, such as colon-delimited varlues. Note that due to the config
13559 parser, it is not possible to use a comma nor a closing parenthesis as
13560 delimitors.
13561
13562 Example:
13563 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
13564 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
13565 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
13566 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
13567
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013568cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013569 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
13570 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013571
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013572crc32([<avalanche>])
13573 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
13574 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13575 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13576 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13577 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13578 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
13579 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
13580 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
13581 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
13582 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013583 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
13584
13585crc32c([<avalanche>])
13586 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
13587 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13588 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13589 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
13590 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
13591 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
13592 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
13593 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013594
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010013595da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013596 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
13597 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
13598 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
13599 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013600 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013601 configuration language.
13602
13603 Example:
13604 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020013605 bind *:8881
13606 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013607 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013608
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020013609debug
13610 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
13611 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
13612 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
13613
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013614div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013615 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13616 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013617 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013618 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
13619 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013620 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013621 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13622 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13623 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13624 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013625 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013626 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013627
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013628djb2([<avalanche>])
13629 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
13630 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13631 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13632 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13633 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13634 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13635 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013636 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
13637 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013638
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013639even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013640 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013641 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
13642
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020013643field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
13644 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
13645 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
13646 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
13647 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
13648 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
13649 fields.
13650
13651 Example :
13652 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
13653 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
13654 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
13655 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
13656 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010013657
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013658hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013659 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013660 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013661 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013662 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010013663
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013664hex2i
13665 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
13666 integer. If the input value can not be converted, then zero is returned.
13667
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013668http_date([<offset>])
13669 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13670 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
13671 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
13672 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
13673 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
13674 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013675
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013676in_table(<table>)
13677 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13678 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
13679 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013680 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013681 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
13682
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013683ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
13684 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013685 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013686 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
13687 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
13688 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
13689 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
13690 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013691
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013692json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013693 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013694 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013695 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013696 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
13697 of errors:
13698 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
13699 bytes, ...)
13700 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
13701 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
13702
13703 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
13704 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
13705 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
13706 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
13707 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
13708 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013709 - "ascii" : never fails;
13710 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
13711 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013712 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013713 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013714 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
13715 characters corresponding to the other errors.
13716
13717 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013718 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013719
13720 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013721 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013722 capture request header user-agent len 150
13723 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013724
13725 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
13726 GET / HTTP/1.0
13727 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
13728
13729 Output log:
13730 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
13731
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013732language(<value>[,<default>])
13733 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
13734 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
13735 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
13736 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
13737 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
13738 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
13739 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
13740 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
13741 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013742 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013743 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
13744 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013745
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013746 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013747
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013748 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
13749 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013750
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013751 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
13752 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
13753 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
13754 use_backend spanish if es
13755 use_backend french if fr
13756 use_backend english if en
13757 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013758
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010013759length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010013760 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
13761 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13762 type. The result is of type integer.
13763
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013764lower
13765 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
13766 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13767 type. The result is of type string.
13768
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013769ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
13770 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13771 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
13772 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13773 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13774 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13775 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
13776
13777 Example :
13778
13779 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013780 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013781 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
13782
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013783map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13784map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13785map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13786 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
13787 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
13788 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
13789 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
13790 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
13791 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
13792 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
13793 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013794
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013795 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
13796 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
13797 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013798
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013799 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013800 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013801
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013802 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
13803 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13804 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
13805 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020013806 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
13807 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013808 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
13809 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13810 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
13811 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13812 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
13813 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13814 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
13815 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080013816 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
13817 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13818 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013819 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13820 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
13821 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13822 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
13823 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013824
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010013825 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
13826 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
13827 the corresponding match text.
13828
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013829 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
13830 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
13831 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
13832 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
13833 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013834
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013835 Example :
13836
13837 # this is a comment and is ignored
13838 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
13839 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
13840 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
13841 | | | `---------- value
13842 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
13843 | `---------------------------- key
13844 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
13845
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013846mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013847 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13848 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013849 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013850 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013851 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013852 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13853 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13854 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13855 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013856 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013857 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013858
13859mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013860 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020013861 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
13862 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013863 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013864 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013865 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013866 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13867 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13868 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13869 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013870 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013871 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013872
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010013873nbsrv
13874 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
13875 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
13876 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
13877 map lookup.
13878
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013879neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013880 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
13881 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
13882 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
13883 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013884
13885not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013886 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013887 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013888 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013889 absence of a flag).
13890
13891odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013892 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013893 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
13894
13895or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013896 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013897 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013898 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13899 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013900 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013901 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13902 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13903 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13904 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013905 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013906 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013907
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010013908protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
13909 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
13910 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
13911 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
13912 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
13913 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
13914 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
13915 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
13916 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
13917 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
13918 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
13919 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
13920
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010013921regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013922 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
13923 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
13924 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
13925 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
13926 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
13927 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
13928 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
13929 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
13930 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
13931 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010013932 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
13933 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
13934 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
13935 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013936
13937 Example :
13938
13939 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
13940 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
13941 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
13942 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
13943
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013944capture-req(<id>)
13945 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
13946 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13947
13948 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013949 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13950 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013951
13952capture-res(<id>)
13953 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
13954 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13955
13956 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013957 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13958 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013959
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013960sdbm([<avalanche>])
13961 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
13962 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13963 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13964 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13965 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13966 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13967 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013968 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
13969 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013970
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013971set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013972 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
13973 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
13974 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013975 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013976 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13977 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013978 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013979 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13980 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013981 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013982 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013983
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020013984sha1
13985 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA1 digest. The result is a binary
13986 sample with length of 20 bytes.
13987
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020013988strcmp(<var>)
13989 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
13990 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
13991 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
13992 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
13993 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
13994 shorter).
13995
13996 Example :
13997
13998 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
13999 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
14000 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
14001
14002
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014003sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014004 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
14005 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014006 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014007 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
14008 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014009 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014010 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14011 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014012 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014013 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14014 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014015 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014016 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014017
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014018table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
14019 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14020 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14021 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
14022 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
14023 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
14024 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
14025
14026
14027table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
14028 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14029 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14030 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
14031 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
14032 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
14033 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
14034
14035table_conn_cnt(<table>)
14036 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14037 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014038 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014039 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
14040 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14041
14042table_conn_cur(<table>)
14043 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14044 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14045 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
14046 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
14047 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
14048
14049table_conn_rate(<table>)
14050 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14051 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14052 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
14053 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
14054 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
14055
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014056table_gpt0(<table>)
14057 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14058 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
14059 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
14060 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
14061 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
14062
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014063table_gpc0(<table>)
14064 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14065 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14066 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
14067 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
14068 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
14069
14070table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
14071 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14072 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14073 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
14074 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
14075 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
14076 sample fetch keyword.
14077
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014078table_gpc1(<table>)
14079 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14080 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14081 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
14082 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
14083 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
14084
14085table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
14086 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14087 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14088 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
14089 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
14090 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
14091 sample fetch keyword.
14092
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014093table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
14094 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14095 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014096 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014097 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
14098 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14099
14100table_http_err_rate(<table>)
14101 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14102 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14103 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
14104 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
14105 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
14106 keyword.
14107
14108table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
14109 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14110 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014111 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014112 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
14113 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14114
14115table_http_req_rate(<table>)
14116 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14117 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14118 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
14119 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
14120 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
14121 keyword.
14122
14123table_kbytes_in(<table>)
14124 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14125 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014126 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014127 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
14128 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
14129 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
14130 keyword.
14131
14132table_kbytes_out(<table>)
14133 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14134 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014135 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014136 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
14137 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
14138 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
14139 keyword.
14140
14141table_server_id(<table>)
14142 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14143 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14144 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
14145 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
14146 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
14147 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
14148
14149table_sess_cnt(<table>)
14150 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14151 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014152 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014153 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
14154 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
14155 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
14156 keyword.
14157
14158table_sess_rate(<table>)
14159 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14160 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14161 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
14162 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
14163 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
14164 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
14165 keyword.
14166
14167table_trackers(<table>)
14168 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14169 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14170 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
14171 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
14172 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
14173 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
14174 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
14175 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
14176 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
14177 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
14178
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014179upper
14180 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
14181 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14182 type. The result is of type string.
14183
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020014184url_dec
14185 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
14186 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
14187
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014188ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014189 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014190 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
14191 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
14192 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014193 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
14194 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
14195 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
14196 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014197 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014198 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
14199 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014200
14201 Example:
14202 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
14203 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
14204
14205 message Point {
14206 int32 latitude = 1;
14207 int32 longitude = 2;
14208 }
14209
14210 message PPoint {
14211 Point point = 59;
14212 }
14213
14214 message Rectangle {
14215 // One corner of the rectangle.
14216 PPoint lo = 48;
14217 // The other corner of the rectangle.
14218 PPoint hi = 49;
14219 }
14220
14221 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
14222 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
14223 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
14224
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014225 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14226 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14227 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latidude" of "hi" second PPoint
14228 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
14229
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014230 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014231
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014232 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014233
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014234 As a gRPC message is alway made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
14235 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14236 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
14237
14238 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
14239 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
14240 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
14241
14242 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
14243 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
14244 interpret the previous binary sample.
14245
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014246
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010014247unset-var(<var name>)
14248 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
14249 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
14250 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
14251 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14252 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
14253 response),
14254 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14255 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
14256 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
14257 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
14258
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014259utime(<format>[,<offset>])
14260 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14261 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
14262 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
14263 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
14264 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
14265 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
14266
14267 Example :
14268
14269 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014270 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014271 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
14272
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014273word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
14274 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
14275 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
14276 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
14277 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
14278 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
14279
14280 Example :
14281 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
14282 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
14283 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
14284 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
14285 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010014286
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014287wt6([<avalanche>])
14288 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
14289 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14290 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14291 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14292 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14293 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14294 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014295 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
14296 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014297
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014298xor(<value>)
14299 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014300 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014301 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014302 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014303 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014304 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14305 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014306 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014307 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14308 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014309 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014310 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014311
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010014312xxh32([<seed>])
14313 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
14314 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14315 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14316 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14317 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14318 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14319 as cryptographically secure.
14320
14321xxh64([<seed>])
14322 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
14323 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14324 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14325 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14326 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14327 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14328 as cryptographically secure.
14329
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014330
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200143317.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014332--------------------------------------------
14333
14334A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
14335not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
14336"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
14337The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
14338
14339always_false : boolean
14340 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14341 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14342
14343always_true : boolean
14344 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14345 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14346
14347avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014348 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014349 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
14350 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
14351 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
14352 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
14353 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
14354 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
14355 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
14356 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
14357 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
14358 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
14359 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
14360 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
14361 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010014362
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014363be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014364 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
14365 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
14366 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
14367 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014368 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
14369
14370be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
14371 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14372 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
14373 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
14374 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
14375 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014376 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
14377 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014378
14379 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
14380 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
14381 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014382
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014383be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
14384 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14385 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14386 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014387 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014388 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
14389 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014390
14391 Example :
14392 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
14393 backend dynamic
14394 mode http
14395 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
14396 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014397
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014398bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014399 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
14400 of the string.
14401
14402bool(<bool>) : bool
14403 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
14404 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
14405
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014406connslots([<backend>]) : integer
14407 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014408 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014409 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
14410 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050014411
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014412 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014413 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014414 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
14415
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014416 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
14417 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014418
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014419 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014420 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014421 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014422 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014423 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014424 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014425 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014426
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014427 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
14428 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014429 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014430 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014431
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014432cpu_calls : integer
14433 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
14434 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
14435 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
14436 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
14437 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
14438 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
14439
14440cpu_ns_avg : integer
14441 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14442 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14443 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14444 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14445 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14446 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14447 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
14448 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
14449 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
14450 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
14451 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14452
14453cpu_ns_tot : integer
14454 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14455 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14456 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14457 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14458 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14459 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14460 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
14461 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
14462 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
14463 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
14464 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
14465 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
14466 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
14467
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014468date([<offset>]) : integer
14469 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
14470 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
14471 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
14472 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020014473 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
14474
14475 Example :
14476
14477 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
14478 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014479
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010014480date_us : integer
14481 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
14482 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
14483 from the same timeval structure.
14484
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020014485distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
14486 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
14487 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
14488 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
14489 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
14490 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
14491 list of supported tokens.
14492
14493distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
14494 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
14495 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
14496 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
14497 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
14498 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
14499 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
14500 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
14501 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
14502 supported tokens.
14503
14504 Example :
14505 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
14506 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
14507 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
14508 # send large files to the big farm
14509 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
14510
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020014511env(<name>) : string
14512 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
14513 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
14514 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
14515 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
14516 certain way.
14517
14518 Examples :
14519 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
14520 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
14521
14522 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
14523 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
14524
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014525fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
14526 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014527 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
14528 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014529 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
14530 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014531 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014532 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
14533 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014534
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020014535fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14536 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
14537 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
14538 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
14539
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014540fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14541 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14542 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14543 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
14544 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
14545 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
14546 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
14547 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
14548 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014549
14550 Example :
14551 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
14552 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
14553 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
14554 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
14555 frontend mail
14556 bind :25
14557 mode tcp
14558 maxconn 100
14559 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
14560 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
14561 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
14562 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014563
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010014564hostname : string
14565 Returns the system hostname.
14566
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014567int(<integer>) : signed integer
14568 Returns a signed integer.
14569
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014570ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
14571 Returns an ipv4.
14572
14573ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
14574 Returns an ipv6.
14575
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014576lat_ns_avg : integer
14577 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14578 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14579 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14580 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14581 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14582 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14583 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14584 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14585 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14586 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14587 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14588 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14589 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex.
14590 Note: this value is exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14591
14592lat_ns_tot : integer
14593 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14594 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14595 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14596 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14597 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14598 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14599 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14600 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14601 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14602 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14603 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14604 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14605 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
14606 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
14607 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
14608 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
14609 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
14610 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
14611 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
14612
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014613meth(<method>) : method
14614 Returns a method.
14615
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014616nbproc : integer
14617 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
14618 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
14619 and debugging purposes.
14620
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014621nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
14622 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
14623 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
14624 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014625 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
14626 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
14627 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014628
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040014629prio_class : integer
14630 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
14631 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
14632 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
14633
14634prio_offset : integer
14635 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
14636 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
14637 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
14638 set-priority-offset".
14639
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014640proc : integer
14641 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
14642 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
14643 debugging purposes.
14644
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014645queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014646 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
14647 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
14648 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014649 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
14650 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
14651 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
14652 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
14653 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
14654
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010014655rand([<range>]) : integer
14656 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
14657 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
14658 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
14659 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
14660 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
14661
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014662srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14663 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14664 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
14665 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
14666 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
14667 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014668 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
14669 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
14670
14671srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14672 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14673 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
14674 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14675 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
14676 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
14677 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
14678 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
14679
14680 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
14681 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014682
14683srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
14684 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
14685 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
14686 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014687 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014688 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
14689 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
14690 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
14691
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020014692srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14693 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
14694 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14695 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
14696 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
14697 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
14698 fetch methods.
14699
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014700srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14701 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14702 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014703 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014704 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
14705 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014706 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014707 overloading servers).
14708
14709 Example :
14710 # Redirect to a separate back
14711 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
14712 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
14713 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
14714
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014715stopping : boolean
14716 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
14717 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
14718 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
14719
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014720str(<string>) : string
14721 Returns a string.
14722
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014723table_avl([<table>]) : integer
14724 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
14725 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
14726
14727table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14728 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
14729 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
14730 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
14731
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010014732thread : integer
14733 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
14734 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
14735 and debugging purposes.
14736
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014737var(<var-name>) : undefined
14738 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014739 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
14740 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014741 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014742 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14743 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014744 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014745 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14746 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014747 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014748 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014749
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200147507.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014751----------------------------------
14752
14753The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
14754closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
14755methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
14756sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
14757TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014758the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
14759counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020014760"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
14761used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
14762can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
14763Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
14764table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
14765tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
14766currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014767
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010014768bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010014769 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14770 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14771 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
14772
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014773be_id : integer
14774 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
14775 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14776
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014777be_name : string
14778 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
14779 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14780
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014781dst : ip
14782 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
14783 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
14784 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
14785 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010014786 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
14787 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
14788 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
14789 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
14790 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
14791 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014792
14793dst_conn : integer
14794 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14795 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
14796 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
14797 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
14798 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
14799 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
14800 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
14801 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014802
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014803dst_is_local : boolean
14804 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
14805 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
14806 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
14807 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014808 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014809 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
14810 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
14811 it only once per connection.
14812
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014813dst_port : integer
14814 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
14815 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
14816 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
14817 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
14818 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
14819 an HTTP header.
14820
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020014821fc_http_major : integer
14822 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14823 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14824 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
14825
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010014826fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
14827 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
14828 header.
14829
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020014830fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
14831 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
14832 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
14833 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
14834 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14835 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14836 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14837
14838fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
14839 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
14840 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
14841 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
14842 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14843 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14844 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14845
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014846fc_unacked(<unit>) : integer
14847 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14848 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14849 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14850 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14851
14852fc_sacked(<unit>) : integer
14853 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14854 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14855 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14856 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14857
14858fc_retrans(<unit>) : integer
14859 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
14860 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14861 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14862 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14863
14864fc_fackets(<unit>) : integer
14865 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
14866 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14867 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14868 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14869
14870fc_lost(<unit>) : integer
14871 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
14872 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14873 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14874 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14875
14876fc_reordering(<unit>) : integer
14877 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
14878 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14879 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14880 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14881
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020014882fe_defbe : string
14883 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
14884 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
14885
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014886fe_id : integer
14887 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010014888 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014889 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14890
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014891fe_name : string
14892 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
14893 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
14894 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14895
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014896sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014897sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14898sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14899sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014900 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
14901 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
14902 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
14903
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014904sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014905sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14906sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14907sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014908 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
14909 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
14910 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
14911
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014912sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014913sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14914sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14915sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014916 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
14917 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014918 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
14919 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14920 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014921
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014922 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014923 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
14924 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014925 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
14926 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
14927 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014928 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
14929 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14930
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014931sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14932sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14933sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14934sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14935 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
14936 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
14937 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
14938 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14939 when a first ACL was verified.
14940
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014941sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014942sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14943sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14944sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014945 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014946 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
14947
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014948sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014949sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
14950sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
14951sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014952 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
14953 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
14954 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
14955
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014956sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014957sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14958sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14959sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014960 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
14961 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
14962 See also src_conn_rate.
14963
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014964sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014965sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14966sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14967sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014968 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014969 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014970
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014971sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14972sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14973sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14974sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14975 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
14976 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
14977
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014978sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14979sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14980sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14981sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14982 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
14983 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
14984
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014985sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014986sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
14987sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
14988sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014989 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
14990 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
14991 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014992 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
14993 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14994 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014995
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014996sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14997sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14998sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14999sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15000 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
15001 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
15002 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
15003 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
15004 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15005 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
15006
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015007sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015008sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15009sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15010sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015011 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015012 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
15013 See also src_http_err_cnt.
15014
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015015sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015016sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15017sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15018sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015019 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
15020 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
15021 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
15022 src_http_err_rate.
15023
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015024sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015025sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15026sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15027sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015028 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015029 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
15030 src_http_req_cnt.
15031
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015032sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015033sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15034sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15035sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015036 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
15037 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
15038 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
15039 src_http_req_rate.
15040
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015041sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015042sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15043sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15044sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015045 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015046 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
15047 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
15048 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
15049 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015050
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015051 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015052 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
15053 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015054 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15055
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015056sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15057sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15058sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15059sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15060 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
15061 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
15062 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
15063 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
15064 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
15065
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015066sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015067sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
15068sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
15069sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015070 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
15071 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
15072 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015073
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015074sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015075sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
15076sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
15077sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015078 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
15079 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
15080 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015081
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015082sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015083sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15084sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15085sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015086 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015087 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
15088 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
15089 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015090 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015091 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
15092
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015093sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015094sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15095sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15096sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015097 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
15098 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15099 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
15100 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
15101 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015102 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015103
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015104sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015105sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
15106sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
15107sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020015108 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
15109 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
15110 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
15111
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015112sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015113sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
15114sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
15115sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015116 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
15117 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015118 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015119 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
15120 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015121 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
15122 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
15123 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015124
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015125so_id : integer
15126 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
15127 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
15128 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015129
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015130src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015131 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015132 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
15133 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
15134 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015135 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
15136 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
15137 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010015138 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
15139 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
15140 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
15141 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
15142 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
15143 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
15144 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015145
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015146 Example:
15147 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
15148 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
15149
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015150src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15151 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
15152 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
15153 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015154 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015155
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015156src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15157 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
15158 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015159 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015160 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015161
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015162src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15163 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15164 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15165 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
15166 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
15167 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
15168 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015169
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015170 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015171 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
15172 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
15173 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
15174 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015175 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015176 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
15177 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15178
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015179src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15180 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15181 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15182 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
15183 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
15184 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
15185 was verified.
15186
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015187src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015188 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015189 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015190 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015191 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015192
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015193src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015194 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015195 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
15196 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015197 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015198
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015199src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15200 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
15201 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15202 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015203 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015204
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015205src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015206 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015207 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015208 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015209 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015210
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015211src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15212 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
15213 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
15214 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
15215 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
15216
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015217src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15218 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
15219 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
15220 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
15221 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
15222
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015223src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015224 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015225 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015226 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
15227 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015228 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
15229 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15230 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015231
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015232src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15233 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
15234 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
15235 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
15236 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
15237 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
15238 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15239 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
15240
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015241src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015242 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015243 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015244 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015245 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015246 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015247
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015248src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15249 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
15250 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15251 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
15252 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015253 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015254
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015255src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015256 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015257 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15258 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015259 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015260
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015261src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15262 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
15263 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15264 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015265 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015266 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015267
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015268src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15269 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15270 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15271 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015272 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015273 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15274 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015275
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015276 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015277 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015278 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015279 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015280
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015281src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15282 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15283 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15284 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
15285 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
15286 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15287 connection when a first ACL was verified.
15288
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015289src_is_local : boolean
15290 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
15291 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
15292 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
15293 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015294 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015295 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
15296 once per connection.
15297
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015298src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015299 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
15300 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
15301 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
15302 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
15303 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015304
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015305src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015306 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
15307 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15308 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
15309 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
15310 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015311
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015312src_port : integer
15313 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
15314 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
15315 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
15316 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015317
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015318src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015319 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015320 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15321 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
15322 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015323 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015324
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015325src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15326 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
15327 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15328 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15329 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015330 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015331
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015332src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15333 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
15334 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
15335 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
15336 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
15337 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
15338 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
15339 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
15340 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015341
15342 Example :
15343 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
15344 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
15345 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
15346 listen ssh
15347 bind :22
15348 mode tcp
15349 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015350 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015351 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015352 server local 127.0.0.1:22
15353
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015354srv_id : integer
15355 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
15356 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
15357 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020015358
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200153597.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015360----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020015361
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015362The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
15363closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
15364when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
15365usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015366future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015367
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001536851d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
15369 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15370 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15371 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
15372 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15373 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15374
15375 Example :
15376 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
15377 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
15378 # the request.
15379 frontend http-in
15380 bind *:8081
15381 default_backend servers
15382 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15383 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15384
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015385ssl_bc : boolean
15386 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15387 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
15388 other a server with the "ssl" option.
15389
15390ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
15391 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
15392 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15393
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015394ssl_bc_alpn : string
15395 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
15396 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
15397 The result is a string containing the protocol name negociated with the
15398 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15399 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15400 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
15401 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
15402 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15403 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn".
15404
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015405ssl_bc_cipher : string
15406 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
15407 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15408
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010015409ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
15410 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15411 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
15412 session or a TLS ticket.
15413
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015414ssl_bc_npn : string
15415 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
15416 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
15417 protocol name negociated with the server . The SSL library must have been
15418 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
15419 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
15420 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
15421 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
15422 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
15423
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015424ssl_bc_protocol : string
15425 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
15426 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15427
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015428ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015429 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015430 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15431 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015432
15433ssl_bc_session_id : binary
15434 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
15435 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
15436 if session was reused or not.
15437
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015438ssl_bc_session_key : binary
15439 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
15440 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15441 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15442 BoringSSL.
15443
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015444ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
15445 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
15446 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15447
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015448ssl_c_ca_err : integer
15449 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15450 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
15451 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
15452 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
15453 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015454
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015455ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
15456 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15457 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
15458 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
15459 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015460
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015461ssl_c_der : binary
15462 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
15463 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15464 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15465
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015466ssl_c_err : integer
15467 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15468 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
15469 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
15470 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
15471 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015472
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015473ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15474 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15475 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15476 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15477 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15478 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15479 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15480 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15481 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015482
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015483ssl_c_key_alg : string
15484 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15485 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15486 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015487
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015488ssl_c_notafter : string
15489 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
15490 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15491 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020015492
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015493ssl_c_notbefore : string
15494 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
15495 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15496 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015497
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015498ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15499 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15500 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15501 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15502 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15503 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15504 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15505 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15506 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015507
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015508ssl_c_serial : binary
15509 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
15510 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15511 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015512
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015513ssl_c_sha1 : binary
15514 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
15515 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
15516 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015517 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
15518 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
15519
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015520 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015521 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015522
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015523ssl_c_sig_alg : string
15524 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15525 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15526 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015527
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015528ssl_c_used : boolean
15529 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
15530 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015531
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015532ssl_c_verify : integer
15533 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
15534 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
15535 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
15536 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015537
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015538ssl_c_version : integer
15539 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
15540 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015541
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015542ssl_f_der : binary
15543 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
15544 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15545 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15546
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015547ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15548 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15549 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15550 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15551 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015552 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015553 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15554 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15555 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015556
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015557ssl_f_key_alg : string
15558 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15559 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
15560 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015561
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015562ssl_f_notafter : string
15563 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15564 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15565 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015566
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015567ssl_f_notbefore : string
15568 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15569 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15570 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015571
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015572ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15573 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15574 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15575 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15576 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15577 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15578 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15579 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15580 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015581
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015582ssl_f_serial : binary
15583 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15584 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15585 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015586
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020015587ssl_f_sha1 : binary
15588 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
15589 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
15590 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
15591
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015592ssl_f_sig_alg : string
15593 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15594 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15595 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015596
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015597ssl_f_version : integer
15598 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15599 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15600
15601ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015602 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15603 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
15604 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
15605
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015606 Example :
15607 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
15608 listen http-https
15609 bind :80
15610 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
15611 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
15612
15613ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
15614 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
15615 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15616
15617ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015618 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015619 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
15620 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
15621 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15622 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15623 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
15624 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
15625 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15626 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
15627
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015628ssl_fc_cipher : string
15629 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
15630 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020015631
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015632ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
15633 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
15634 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015635 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015636
15637ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
15638 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
15639 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015640 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015641
15642ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
15643 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
15644 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
15645 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015646 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020015647 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015648
15649ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
15650 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
15651 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015652 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015653
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015654ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015655 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
15656 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010015657 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
15658 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
15659 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
15660 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015661
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020015662ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
15663 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
15664 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
15665 wait until the handshake happened.
15666
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015667ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
15668 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020015669 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
15670 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
15671 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
15672 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015673
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020015674ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015675 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010015676 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
15677 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015678
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015679ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015680 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015681 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
15682 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
15683 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
15684 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
15685 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
15686 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
15687 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020015688
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015689ssl_fc_protocol : string
15690 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
15691 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015692
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015693ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015694 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015695 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15696 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015697
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015698ssl_fc_session_id : binary
15699 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
15700 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
15701 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
15702 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015703
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015704ssl_fc_session_key : binary
15705 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
15706 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15707 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15708 BoringSSL.
15709
15710
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015711ssl_fc_sni : string
15712 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
15713 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
15714 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
15715 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
15716 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
15717
15718 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
15719 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
15720 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020015721 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
15722 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015723
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015724 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015725 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
15726 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020015727
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015728ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
15729 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
15730 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015731
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015732
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200157337.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015734------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015735
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015736Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
15737sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
15738only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
15739For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
15740be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
15741can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
15742sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
15743for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
15744content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015745
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015746payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015747 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015748 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
15749 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015750
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015751payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
15752 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015753 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015754 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015755
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020015756req.hdrs : string
15757 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
15758 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
15759 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
15760 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
15761
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020015762req.hdrs_bin : binary
15763 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
15764 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
15765 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
15766 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
15767 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
15768 names and values (length of 0 for both).
15769
15770 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
15771
15772 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
15773 str: <int:length><bytes>
15774
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015775req.len : integer
15776req_len : integer (deprecated)
15777 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15778 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15779 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15780 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15781 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15782 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15783 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
15784 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015785
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015786req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15787 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015788 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15789 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15790 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15791 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015792
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015793 ACL alternatives :
15794 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015795
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015796req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15797 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15798 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15799 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
15800 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015801
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015802 ACL alternatives :
15803 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015804
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015805 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015806
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015807req.proto_http : boolean
15808req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
15809 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
15810 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
15811 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
15812 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
15813 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
15814 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
15815 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015816
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015817 Example:
15818 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
15819 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15820 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015821 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015822
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015823req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
15824rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15825 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
15826 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
15827 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
15828 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
15829 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
15830 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
15831 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015832
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015833 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
15834 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
15835 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
15836 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
15837 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
15838 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015839
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015840 ACL derivatives :
15841 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015842
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015843 Example :
15844 listen tse-farm
15845 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
15846 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
15847 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15848 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
15849 # apply RDP cookie persistence
15850 persist rdp-cookie
15851 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
15852 # This is only useful makes sense if
15853 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
15854 stick-table type string size 204800
15855 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
15856 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
15857 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015858
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015859 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
15860 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015861
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015862req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
15863rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
15864 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
15865 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
15866 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
15867 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015868
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015869 ACL derivatives :
15870 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015871
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015872req.ssl_alpn : string
15873 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
15874 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
15875 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
15876 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
15877 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
15878 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020015879 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015880
15881 Examples :
15882 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
15883 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15884 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020015885 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015886 default_backend bk_default
15887
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020015888req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
15889 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
15890 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020015891 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
15892 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
15893 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
15894 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
15895 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020015896
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015897req.ssl_hello_type : integer
15898req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
15899 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
15900 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
15901 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
15902 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
15903 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
15904 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
15905 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015906
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015907req.ssl_sni : string
15908req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
15909 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
15910 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
15911 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
15912 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
15913 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
15914 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
15915 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
15916 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
15917 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
15918 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
15919 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
15920 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015921
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015922 ACL derivatives :
15923 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015924
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015925 Examples :
15926 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
15927 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15928 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
15929 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
15930 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015931
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053015932req.ssl_st_ext : integer
15933 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
15934 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
15935 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
15936 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
15937 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
15938 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
15939 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
15940 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
15941 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
15942
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015943req.ssl_ver : integer
15944req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
15945 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
15946 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
15947 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
15948 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
15949 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
15950 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
15951 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015952 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015953 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015954
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015955 ACL derivatives :
15956 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015957
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020015958res.len : integer
15959 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15960 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15961 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15962 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15963 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15964 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15965 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
15966 content inspection.
15967
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015968res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15969 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015970 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15971 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15972 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15973 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015974
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015975res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15976 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15977 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15978 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
15979 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015980
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015981 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015982
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020015983res.ssl_hello_type : integer
15984rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
15985 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
15986 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
15987 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
15988 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
15989 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
15990 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
15991 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
15992
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015993wait_end : boolean
15994 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
15995 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015996 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015997 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
15998 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015999 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016000 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
16001 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016002
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016003 Examples :
16004 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
16005 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
16006 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016007
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016008 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
16009 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16010 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
16011 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
16012 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
16013 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
16014 tcp-request content reject
16015
16016
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200160177.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016018--------------------------------------
16019
16020It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
16021This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
16022data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
16023its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
16024HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
16025content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
16026to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
16027more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
16028response are indexed.
16029
16030base : string
16031 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
16032 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
16033 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
16034 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
16035 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
16036 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
16037 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
16038 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
16039
16040 ACL derivatives :
16041 base : exact string match
16042 base_beg : prefix match
16043 base_dir : subdir match
16044 base_dom : domain match
16045 base_end : suffix match
16046 base_len : length match
16047 base_reg : regex match
16048 base_sub : substring match
16049
16050base32 : integer
16051 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
16052 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
16053 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016054 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
16055 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
16056 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016057
16058base32+src : binary
16059 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
16060 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
16061 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
16062 per-URL counters.
16063
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010016064capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
16065 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
16066 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
16067 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
16068
16069capture.req.method : string
16070 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
16071 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
16072 because it's allocated.
16073
16074capture.req.uri : string
16075 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
16076 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
16077 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
16078 allocated.
16079
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020016080capture.req.ver : string
16081 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
16082 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
16083 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
16084
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010016085capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
16086 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
16087 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
16088 The first entry is an index of 0.
16089 See also: "capture response header"
16090
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020016091capture.res.ver : string
16092 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
16093 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
16094 persistent flag.
16095
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020016096req.body : binary
16097 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
16098 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
16099 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
16100 the first chunk is analyzed.
16101
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020016102req.body_param([<name>) : string
16103 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
16104 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
16105 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
16106 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
16107 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
16108 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
16109 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
16110 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
16111 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
16112 given.
16113
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020016114req.body_len : integer
16115 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
16116 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
16117 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
16118 "option http-buffer-request".
16119
16120req.body_size : integer
16121 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
16122 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
16123 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
16124 that the request body has been buffered made available using
16125 "option http-buffer-request".
16126
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016127req.cook([<name>]) : string
16128cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16129 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16130 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16131 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
16132 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
16133 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
16134 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
16135 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
16136 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
16137
16138 ACL derivatives :
16139 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
16140 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
16141 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
16142 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
16143 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
16144 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
16145 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
16146 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016147
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016148req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16149cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16150 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16151 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016152
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016153req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16154cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16155 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16156 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
16157 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
16158 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016159
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016160cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16161 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16162 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
16163 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
16164 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016165 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016166 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
16167 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
16168 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
16169 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016170
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016171hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16172 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
16173 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
16174 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
16175 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016176 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016177
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016178req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
16179 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
16180 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
16181 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16182 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16183 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16184 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
16185 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
16186 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016187
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016188req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16189 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
16190 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16191 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16192 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016193
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016194req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16195 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
16196 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
16197 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16198 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16199 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16200 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
16201 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
16202 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000016203 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016204 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016205 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016206
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016207 ACL derivatives :
16208 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16209 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16210 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16211 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16212 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16213 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16214 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16215 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16216
16217req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16218hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
16219 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
16220 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
16221 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
16222 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
16223 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
16224 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
16225 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
16226 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
16227 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
16228
16229req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16230hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16231 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
16232 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
16233 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
16234 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16235 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016236 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016237 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
16238 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
16239
16240req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16241hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16242 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
16243 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
16244 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
16245 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16246 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16247 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16248 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
16249
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010016250
16251
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016252http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
16253 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
16254 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
16255 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16256 basic auth is supported.
16257
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016258http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
16259 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
16260 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
16261 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
16262 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016263 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16264 basic auth is supported.
16265
16266 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016267 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
16268 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
16269 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
16270 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016271
16272http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016273 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
16274 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016275 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
16276 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016277
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016278method : integer + string
16279 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
16280 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
16281 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
16282 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
16283 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
16284 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
16285 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016286
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016287 ACL derivatives :
16288 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016289
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016290 Example :
16291 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
16292 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
16293 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016294
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016295path : string
16296 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
16297 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
16298 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
16299 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
16300 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016301 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016302 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016303
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016304 ACL derivatives :
16305 path : exact string match
16306 path_beg : prefix match
16307 path_dir : subdir match
16308 path_dom : domain match
16309 path_end : suffix match
16310 path_len : length match
16311 path_reg : regex match
16312 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016313
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016314query : string
16315 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
16316 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
16317 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
16318 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016319 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016320 which stops before the question mark.
16321
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016322req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16323 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16324 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16325 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16326 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16327
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016328req.ver : string
16329req_ver : string (deprecated)
16330 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
16331 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
16332 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016333
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016334 ACL derivatives :
16335 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016336
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016337res.comp : boolean
16338 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
16339 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
16340 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016341
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016342res.comp_algo : string
16343 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
16344 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
16345 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016346
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016347res.cook([<name>]) : string
16348scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16349 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16350 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16351 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016352
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016353 ACL derivatives :
16354 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016355
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016356res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16357scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16358 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16359 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
16360 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016361
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016362res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16363scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16364 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16365 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
16366 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016367
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016368res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16369 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16370 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16371 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16372 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16373 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
16374 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
16375 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
16376 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
16377 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016378
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016379res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16380 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16381 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16382 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16383 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
16384 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016385
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016386res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16387shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
16388 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16389 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16390 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16391 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16392 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
16393 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
16394 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
16395 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016396
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016397 ACL derivatives :
16398 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16399 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16400 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16401 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16402 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16403 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16404 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16405 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16406
16407res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16408shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16409 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16410 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16411 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
16412 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
16413 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016414
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016415res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16416shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16417 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
16418 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
16419 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
16420 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
16421 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
16422 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016423
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016424res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16425 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16426 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16427 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16428 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16429
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016430res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16431shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16432 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
16433 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16434 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
16435 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
16436 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
16437 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016438
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016439res.ver : string
16440resp_ver : string (deprecated)
16441 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
16442 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016443
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016444 ACL derivatives :
16445 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016446
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016447set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16448 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16449 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016450 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016451 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016452
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016453 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
16454 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016455
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016456status : integer
16457 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
16458 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
16459 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016460
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020016461unique-id : string
16462 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
16463 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
16464 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
16465 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
16466 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
16467 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
16468
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016469url : string
16470 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
16471 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
16472 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
16473 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
16474 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
16475 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
16476 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016477
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016478 ACL derivatives :
16479 url : exact string match
16480 url_beg : prefix match
16481 url_dir : subdir match
16482 url_dom : domain match
16483 url_end : suffix match
16484 url_len : length match
16485 url_reg : regex match
16486 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016487
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016488url_ip : ip
16489 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
16490 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
16491 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
16492 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
16493 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
16494 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16495 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016496
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016497url_port : integer
16498 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
16499 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
16500 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16501 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016502
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016503urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
16504url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016505 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
16506 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016507 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
16508 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
16509 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
16510 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016511 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
16512 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016513 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
16514 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016515
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016516 ACL derivatives :
16517 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
16518 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
16519 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
16520 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
16521 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
16522 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
16523 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
16524 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016525
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016526
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016527 Example :
16528 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
16529 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
16530 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
16531 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016532
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016533urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016534 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
16535 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
16536 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020016537
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020016538url32 : integer
16539 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
16540 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
16541 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
16542 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
16543 is an unsigned integer.
16544
16545url32+src : binary
16546 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
16547 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
16548 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
16549
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010016550
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200165517.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016552---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016553
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016554Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
16555every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020016556order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016557
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016558ACL name Equivalent to Usage
16559---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016560FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020016561HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016562HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
16563HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016564HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
16565HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
16566HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
16567HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
16568LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016569METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016570METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016571METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
16572METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
16573METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
16574METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016575METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016576METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020016577RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016578REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016579TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016580WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
16581---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016582
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010016583
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200165848. Logging
16585----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010016586
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016587One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
16588provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
16589very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
16590provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
16591state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016592to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016593headers.
16594
16595In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
16596about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
16597send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
16598
16599 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
16600 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
16601 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
16602 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
16603 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016604 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060016605 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016606
16607The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
16608allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
16609as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
16610while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
16611real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
16612delay.
16613
16614
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200166158.1. Log levels
16616---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016617
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016618TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016619source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016620HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
16621in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
16622track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
16623syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
16624about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016625
16626
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200166278.2. Log formats
16628----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016629
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016630HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016631and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
16632slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
16633options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016634
16635 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
16636 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
16637 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
16638 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
16639 extents.
16640
16641 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
16642 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
16643 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
16644 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
16645 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
16646
16647 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
16648 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
16649 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
16650 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
16651 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
16652
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020016653 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
16654 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
16655 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
16656 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
16657
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016658 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
16659
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016660Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
16661specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
16662field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
16663servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
16664always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
16665identifier.
16666
16667Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
16668 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
16669 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
16670 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
16671 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
16672
16673
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200166748.2.1. Default log format
16675-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016676
16677This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
16678as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
16679format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
16680
16681 Example :
16682 listen www
16683 mode http
16684 log global
16685 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16686
16687 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
16688 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
16689 (www/HTTP)
16690
16691 Field Format Extract from the example above
16692 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
16693 2 'Connect from' Connect from
16694 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
16695 4 'to' to
16696 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
16697 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
16698
16699Detailed fields description :
16700 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
16701 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
16702 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
16703 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
16704 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16705 and processed the connection.
16706 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
16707
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016708In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
16709"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
16710connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
16711
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016712It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
16713will eventually disappear.
16714
16715
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200167168.2.2. TCP log format
16717---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016718
16719The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
16720is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
16721information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
16722counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
16723emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
16724environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
16725the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
16726sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016727specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
16728not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
16729fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
16730marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016731
16732 Example :
16733 frontend fnt
16734 mode tcp
16735 option tcplog
16736 log global
16737 default_backend bck
16738
16739 backend bck
16740 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16741
16742 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
16743 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
16744 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
16745
16746 Field Format Extract from the example above
16747 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
16748 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
16749 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
16750 4 frontend_name fnt
16751 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
16752 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
16753 7 bytes_read* 212
16754 8 termination_state --
16755 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
16756 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
16757
16758Detailed fields description :
16759 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016760 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
16761 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
16762 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016763 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016764 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016765 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016766
16767 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016768 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
16769 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
16770 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016771
16772 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
16773 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
16774 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016775 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
16776 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
16777 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
16778 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016779
16780 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16781 and processed the connection.
16782
16783 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
16784 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
16785 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
16786 applications.
16787
16788 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
16789 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
16790 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
16791 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
16792 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
16793
16794 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
16795 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
16796 See "Timers" below for more details.
16797
16798 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
16799 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
16800 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
16801 "Timers" below for more details.
16802
16803 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016804 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016805 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
16806 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
16807 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
16808 details.
16809
16810 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
16811 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
16812 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
16813 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
16814 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
16815
16816 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
16817 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
16818 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
16819 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
16820 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
16821 for more details.
16822
16823 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016824 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016825 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
16826 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
16827 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016828 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016829
16830 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
16831 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
16832 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
16833 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
16834 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
16835 caused by a denial of service attack.
16836
16837 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
16838 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
16839 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
16840 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
16841 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
16842 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
16843 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
16844 denial of service attack.
16845
16846 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
16847 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
16848 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
16849 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
16850 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
16851 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
16852 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
16853 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
16854 be processed than on other servers.
16855
16856 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
16857 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
16858 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
16859 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
16860 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
16861 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
16862 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
16863 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
16864 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
16865 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
16866 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
16867 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
16868 should not be attributed to the logged server.
16869
16870 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16871 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
16872 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
16873 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
16874 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
16875 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016876 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016877 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
16878
16879 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16880 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
16881 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
16882 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
16883 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
16884 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016885 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016886 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
16887 occurs.
16888
16889
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200168908.2.3. HTTP log format
16891----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016892
16893The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
16894is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
16895the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
16896are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
16897emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
16898generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
16899"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
16900which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016901frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
16902is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016903
16904Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
16905slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
16906with a star ('*') after the field name below.
16907
16908 Example :
16909 frontend http-in
16910 mode http
16911 option httplog
16912 log global
16913 default_backend bck
16914
16915 backend static
16916 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16917
16918 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
16919 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
16920 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016921 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016922
16923 Field Format Extract from the example above
16924 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
16925 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016926 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016927 4 frontend_name http-in
16928 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016929 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016930 7 status_code 200
16931 8 bytes_read* 2750
16932 9 captured_request_cookie -
16933 10 captured_response_cookie -
16934 11 termination_state ----
16935 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
16936 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
16937 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
16938 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
16939 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016940
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016941Detailed fields description :
16942 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016943 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
16944 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
16945 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016946 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016947 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016948 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016949
16950 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016951 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
16952 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
16953 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016954
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016955 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
16956 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016957
16958 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16959 and processed the connection.
16960
16961 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
16962 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
16963 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
16964
16965 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
16966 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
16967 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
16968 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
16969 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
16970 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
16971
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016972 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
16973 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
16974 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
16975 request could be received or the a bad request was received. It should
16976 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
16977 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016978 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
16979 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016980
16981 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
16982 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016983 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016984
16985 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
16986 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016987 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
16988 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016989
16990 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
16991 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
16992 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
16993 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
16994 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016995 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
16996 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016997
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016998 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
16999 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
17000 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
17001 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
17002 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
17003 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
17004 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017005 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017006
17007 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
17008 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
17009 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
17010
17011 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
17012 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
17013 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
17014 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
17015 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
17016 overflowing.
17017
17018 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
17019 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
17020 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
17021 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
17022 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
17023 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
17024 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
17025 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
17026
17027 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
17028 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
17029 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
17030 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
17031 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
17032 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
17033 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
17034 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
17035
17036 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
17037 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
17038 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
17039 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
17040 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
17041 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
17042 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
17043
17044 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017045 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017046 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
17047 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
17048 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017049 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017050 system.
17051
17052 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
17053 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
17054 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
17055 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
17056 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
17057 caused by a denial of service attack.
17058
17059 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
17060 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
17061 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
17062 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
17063 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
17064 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
17065 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
17066 denial of service attack.
17067
17068 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
17069 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
17070 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
17071 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
17072 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
17073 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
17074 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
17075 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
17076 processed than on other servers.
17077
17078 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
17079 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
17080 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
17081 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
17082 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
17083 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
17084 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
17085 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
17086 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
17087 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
17088 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
17089 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
17090 should not be attributed to the logged server.
17091
17092 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17093 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
17094 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
17095 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
17096 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
17097 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017098 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017099 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
17100
17101 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17102 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
17103 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
17104 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
17105 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
17106 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017107 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017108 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
17109 occurs.
17110
17111 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
17112 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
17113 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
17114 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
17115 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
17116 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
17117 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
17118 cookies" below for more details.
17119
17120 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
17121 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
17122 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
17123 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
17124 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
17125 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
17126 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
17127 and cookies" below for more details.
17128
17129 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
17130 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
17131 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
17132 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
17133 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
17134 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
17135 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
17136 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
17137
17138
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200171398.2.4. Custom log format
17140------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017141
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017142The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017143mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017144
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017145HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017146Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
17147separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
17148prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
17149
17150Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
17151variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017152("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017153
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010017154If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020017155as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010017156less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
17157the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
17158
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017159Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017160In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010017161in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017162
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017163Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
17164'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
17165https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
17166such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
17167
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017168Flags are :
17169 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017170 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017171 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
17172 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017173
17174 Example:
17175
17176 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
17177 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
17178
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017179 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
17180
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017181At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
17182
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017183 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
17184 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017185
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017186the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017187
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017188 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
17189 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
17190 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017191
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017192and the default TCP format is defined this way :
17193
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017194 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
17195 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017196
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017197Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
17198
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017199 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017200 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017201 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
17202 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
17203 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017204 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
17205 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
17206 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017207 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000017208 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
17209 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000017210 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000017211 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
17212 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010017213 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020017214 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017215 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017216 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017217 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020017218 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080017219 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017220 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
17221 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
17222 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
17223 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
17224 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017225 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017226 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
17227 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017228 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017229 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
17230 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017231 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
17232 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
17233 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017234 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017235 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
17236 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017237 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017238 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
17239 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
17240 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020017241 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020017242 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020017243 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
17244 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
17245 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
17246 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020017247 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017248 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017249 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017250 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010017251 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017252 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017253 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
17254 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
17255 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017256 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017257 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
17258 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017259 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017260 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
17261 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020017262 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017263 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017264 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017265 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017266
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017267 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017268
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017269
172708.2.5. Error log format
17271-----------------------
17272
17273When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
17274protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
17275By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
17276"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017277will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017278logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
17279
17280The format looks like this :
17281
17282 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
17283 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
17284 Connection error during SSL handshake
17285
17286 Field Format Extract from the example above
17287 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
17288 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
17289 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
17290 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
17291 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
17292
17293These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
17294failures.
17295
17296
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172978.3. Advanced logging options
17298-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017299
17300Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
17301just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
17302options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
17303for more information about their usage.
17304
17305
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173068.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
17307------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017308
17309It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
17310haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
17311commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
17312monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
17313ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
17314
17315 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
17316 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
17317 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
17318 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
17319
17320 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
17321 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
17322 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017323 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017324 such as other load-balancers.
17325
17326 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
17327 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
17328 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
17329
17330
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173318.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
17332----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017333
17334The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
17335what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
17336or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017337"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017338just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
17339log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
17340after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
17341is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
17342with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
17343with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
17344
17345
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173468.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
17347------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017348
17349Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
17350for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
17351"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
17352retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
17353raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
17354a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
17355file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
17356you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
17357"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
17358
17359
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173608.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
17361--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017362
17363Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
17364multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
17365them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
17366"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
17367logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
17368error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
17369and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
17370too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
17371useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
17372alternative.
17373
17374
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173758.4. Timing events
17376------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017377
17378Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
17379reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
17380the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
17381frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017382mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
17383addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
17384
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010017385Timings events in HTTP mode:
17386
17387 first request 2nd request
17388 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
17389 t tr t tr ...
17390 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
17391 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
17392 :<---- Tq ---->: :
17393 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
17394 :<--------- Ta --------->:
17395
17396Timings events in TCP mode:
17397
17398 TCP session
17399 |<----------------->|
17400 t t
17401 ---|----|----|----|----|---
17402 | Th Tw Tc Td |
17403 |<------ Tt ------->|
17404
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017405 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017406 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017407 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
17408 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
17409 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017410 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017411 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
17412 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
17413 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
17414 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017415
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017416 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
17417 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
17418 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017419 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
17420 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
17421 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
17422 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
17423 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
17424 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017425
17426 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
17427 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
17428 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
17429 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
17430 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
17431 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
17432 request typed by hand during a test.
17433
17434 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
17435 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017436 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017437 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
17438 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
17439 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
17440 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017441
17442 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
17443 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
17444 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
17445 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
17446 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
17447
17448 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
17449 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
17450 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
17451 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
17452 connection never established.
17453
17454 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
17455 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
17456 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
17457 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
17458 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
17459 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
17460 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
17461 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
17462 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
17463 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
17464 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
17465
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017466 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
17467 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
17468 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
17469 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
17470 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
17471 by subtracting other timers when valid :
17472
17473 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
17474
17475 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
17476 "Ta" can never be negative.
17477
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017478 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
17479 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017480 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
17481 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017482 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017483
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017484 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017485
17486 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017487 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
17488 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017489
17490These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
17491protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
17492that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017493due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
17494"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
17495that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017496
17497Most common cases :
17498
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017499 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
17500 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
17501 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
17502 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
17503 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
17504 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
17505 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
17506 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
17507 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
17508 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
17509 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020017510 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017511
17512 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
17513 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
17514 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
17515 of ms on remote networks.
17516
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017517 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
17518 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
17519 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017520
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017521 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
17522 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
17523 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
17524 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
17525 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
17526 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
17527 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
17528 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
17529 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017530
17531Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
17532
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017533 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017534 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017535 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017536
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017537 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017538 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
17539 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
17540
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017541 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017542 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
17543 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
17544 flags.
17545
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017546 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
17547 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017548 Check the session termination flags, then check the
17549 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
17550 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
17551 the client connection was maintained open.
17552
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017553 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017554 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017555 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017556 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
17557
17558
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200175598.5. Session state at disconnection
17560-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017561
17562TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
17563"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
175642-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
17565each of which has a special meaning :
17566
17567 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
17568 session to terminate :
17569
17570 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
17571
17572 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
17573 server explicitly refused it.
17574
17575 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
17576 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
17577 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
17578 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017579 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017580
17581 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
17582 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017583
17584 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
17585 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
17586 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
17587 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
17588 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
17589
17590 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
17591 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
17592 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
17593 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
17594 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
17595
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090017596 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
17597 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
17598
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070017599 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
17600 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
17601 backup connections when going up.
17602
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020017603 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
17604
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017605 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
17606 send or receive data.
17607
17608 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
17609 send or receive data.
17610
17611 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
17612 with nothing left in the buffers.
17613
17614 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
17615
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010017616 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017617 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
17618
17619 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
17620 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
17621 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
17622 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
17623 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
17624
17625 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
17626 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
17627
17628 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
17629 server (HTTP only).
17630
17631 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
17632
17633 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
17634 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
17635 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
17636
17637 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
17638 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
17639 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
17640
17641 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
17642
17643 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
17644 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
17645
17646 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
17647 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
17648 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
17649
17650 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
17651 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020017652 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
17653 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017654
17655 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
17656 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
17657 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
17658 another server.
17659
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017660 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017661 server.
17662
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017663 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
17664 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
17665 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
17666 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17667
17668 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
17669 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
17670 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
17671 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17672
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020017673 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
17674 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
17675 "use-server" rule).
17676
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017677 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17678
17679 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
17680 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
17681
17682 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
17683
17684 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
17685 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
17686 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
17687
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017688 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
17689 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017690 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017691 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
17692 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
17693
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017694 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
17695
17696 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
17697 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
17698
17699 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
17700
17701 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17702
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017703The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
17704was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017705helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
17706starvation, attacks, etc...
17707
17708The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
17709alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
17710easier finding and understanding.
17711
17712 Flags Reason
17713
17714 -- Normal termination.
17715
17716 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
17717 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
17718 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
17719 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
17720
17721 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
17722 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
17723 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
17724 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
17725 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
17726 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017727
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017728 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17729 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017730 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017731
17732 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
17733 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
17734 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
17735
17736 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
17737 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
17738 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
17739 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
17740 the server takes too long to respond.
17741
17742 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
17743 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
17744 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
17745 long a time to respond.
17746
17747 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
17748 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
17749 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
17750 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017751 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
17752 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017753
17754 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
17755 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
17756 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
17757 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
17758 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020017759 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017760 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
17761 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
17762 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
17763 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
17764 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
17765 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
17766 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
17767 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017768 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017769 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
17770 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
17771 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017772
17773 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
17774 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017775 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
17776 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
17777 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
17778 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017779
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017780 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
17781 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
17782
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017783 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017784 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
17785 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017786 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017787 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
17788 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
17789
17790 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
17791 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
17792 503 or 504 here.
17793
17794 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
17795 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
17796 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
17797 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
17798 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
17799
17800 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17801 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017802 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017803 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
17804 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
17805
17806 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
17807 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
17808 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
17809 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
17810 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
17811 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
17812 between haproxy and the server.
17813
17814 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
17815 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
17816 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
17817 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
17818 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
17819 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
17820 solution is to fix the application.
17821
17822 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
17823 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
17824 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
17825 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
17826 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
17827 external attacks.
17828
17829 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
17830 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017831 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017832 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
17833 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
17834
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017835 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
17836 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
17837 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017838 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020017839 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017840
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017841 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
17842 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
17843 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
17844 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017845 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
17846 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
17847 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
17848 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
17849 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017850
17851 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
17852 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
17853 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
17854 returned an HTTP 403 error.
17855
17856 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
17857 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
17858 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
17859 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
17860
17861 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
17862 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
17863 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
17864 only be solved by proper system tuning.
17865
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017866The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
17867persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
17868important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
17869re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
17870
17871 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
17872
17873 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
17874 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
17875 set on a GET request.
17876
17877 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
17878 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017879 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017880 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
17881
17882 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
17883 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
17884 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
17885
17886 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
17887 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
17888 already got a cookie.
17889
17890 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
17891 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
17892 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
17893 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
17894 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
17895
17896 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
17897 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
17898 new cookie was inserted in the response.
17899
17900 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
17901 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
17902 new cookie was inserted in the response.
17903
17904 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
17905 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
17906
17907 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
17908 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
17909 then advertised in the response.
17910
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017911
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179128.6. Non-printable characters
17913-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017914
17915In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
17916consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
17917converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
17918prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
17919being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
17920escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
17921is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
17922'}' when logging headers.
17923
17924Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
17925issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
17926containing spaces is "User-Agent".
17927
17928Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
17929the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
17930performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
17931
17932
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179338.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
17934---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017935
17936Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
17937achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017938section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017939cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
17940the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
17941the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017942locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017943not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
17944user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
17945a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
17946wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
17947
17948 Examples :
17949 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
17950 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
17951
17952 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
17953 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
17954
17955
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179568.8. Capturing HTTP headers
17957---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017958
17959Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
17960proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
17961the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
17962server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
17963
17964Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
17965response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017966section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017967
17968It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017969time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
17970appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017971are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
17972and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
17973follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
17974request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
17975in the logs.
17976
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020017977As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
17978frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
17979an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
17980
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017981 Example :
17982 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
17983 listen proxy-out
17984 mode http
17985 option httplog
17986 option logasap
17987 log global
17988 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
17989
17990 # log the name of the virtual server
17991 capture request header Host len 20
17992
17993 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
17994 capture request header Content-Length len 10
17995
17996 # log the beginning of the referrer
17997 capture request header Referer len 20
17998
17999 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
18000 capture response header Server len 20
18001
18002 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
18003 capture response header Content-Length len 10
18004
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018005 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018006 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
18007
18008 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
18009 capture response header Via len 20
18010
18011 # log the URL location during a redirection
18012 capture response header Location len 20
18013
18014 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
18015 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
18016 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18017 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
18018 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
18019
18020 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
18021 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
18022 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18023 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018024 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018025
18026 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
18027 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
18028 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18029 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
18030 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018031 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018032
18033
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180348.9. Examples of logs
18035---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018036
18037These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
18038them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
18039reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
18040
18041 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
18042 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
18043 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
18044
18045 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
18046 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
18047
18048 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
18049 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
18050 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
18051
18052 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
18053 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
18054
18055 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
18056 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
18057 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
18058
18059 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018060 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018061 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
18062 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
18063
18064 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
18065 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
18066 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
18067
18068 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
18069 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020018070 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018071 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
18072 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
18073 to return the 502 and not the server.
18074
18075 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018076 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018077
18078 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
18079 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
18080 Nothing was sent to any server.
18081
18082 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
18083 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
18084
18085 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
18086 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018087 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018088 send a 408 return code to the client.
18089
18090 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
18091 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
18092
18093 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
18094 5 seconds ("c----").
18095
18096 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
18097 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018098 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018099
18100 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018101 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018102 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
18103 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
18104 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
18105 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
18106 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010018107
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020018108
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200181099. Supported filters
18110--------------------
18111
18112Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
18113accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
18114unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
18115
18116See also : "filter"
18117
181189.1. Trace
18119----------
18120
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010018121filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018122
18123 Arguments:
18124 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
18125 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
18126
18127 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
18128 the client and the server. By default, this filter
18129 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
18130 only parses a random amount of the available data.
18131
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018132 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018133 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
18134 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
18135 amount of the parsed data.
18136
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018137 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010018138
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018139This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
18140callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
18141information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
18142filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
18143
18144Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
18145tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
18146a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
18147
18148
181499.2. HTTP compression
18150---------------------
18151
18152filter compression
18153
18154The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
18155keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018156when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache enabled,
18157it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always done after the
18158response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter
18159line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one filter other than the
18160cache is used for the same listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know
18161the filters evaluation order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018162
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018163See also : "compression" and section 9.4 about the cache filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018164
18165
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200181669.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
18167--------------------------------------------
18168
18169filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
18170
18171 Arguments :
18172
18173 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
18174 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
18175 parsed.
18176
18177 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
18178 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
18179 part must be placed in its own scope.
18180
18181The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
18182external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018183streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020018184exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
18185also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
18186
18187SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
18188the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
18189
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010018190For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020018191"doc/SPOE.txt".
18192
18193Important note:
18194 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
18195 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
18196
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100181979.4. Cache
18198----------
18199
18200filter cache <name>
18201
18202 Arguments :
18203
18204 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
18205
18206The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
18207"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
18208cache. By default the correpsonding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018209other filters than cache or compression are used, it is enough. In such case,
18210the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it is
18211mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
18212filter other than the compression is used for the same
18213listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
18214order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018215
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018216See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter and section 10 about cache.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018217
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01001821810. Cache
18219---------
18220
18221HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
18222(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
18223RAM.
18224
18225The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010018226this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018227
18228If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
18229independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
18230when we try to allocate a new one.
18231
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010018232The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018233
18234It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
18235"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
18236for more details.
18237
18238When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
18239replaced by "<CACHE>".
18240
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001824110.1. Limitation
18242----------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018243
18244The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
18245
18246- If the response is not a 200
18247- If the response contains a Vary header
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020018248- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018249- If the response is not cacheable
18250
18251- If the request is not a GET
18252- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
William Lallemand8a16fe02018-05-22 11:04:33 +020018253- If the request contains an Authorization header
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018254
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018255Caution!: For HAProxy version prior to 1.9, due to the limitation of the
18256filters, it is not recommended to use the cache with other filters. Using them
18257can cause undefined behavior if they modify the response (compression for
18258example). For HAProxy 1.9 and greater, it is safe, for HTX proxies only (see
18259"option http-use-htx" for details).
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018260
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001826110.2. Setup
18262-----------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018263
18264To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
18265the corresponding http-request and response actions.
18266
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001826710.2.1. Cache section
18268---------------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018269
18270cache <name>
18271 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
18272 size of cache is mandatory.
18273
18274total-max-size <megabytes>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018275 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
Frédéric Lécaillee3c83d82018-10-25 10:46:40 +020018276 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018277
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020018278max-object-size <bytes>
Frédéric Lécaillee3c83d82018-10-25 10:46:40 +020018279 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
18280 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
18281 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020018282
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018283max-age <seconds>
18284 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
18285 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
18286 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
18287 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
18288 default.
18289
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001829010.2.2. Proxy section
18291---------------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018292
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +020018293http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018294 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
18295 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
18296 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
18297 after this one.
18298
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +020018299http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018300 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
18301 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
18302 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
18303 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
18304
18305
18306Example:
18307
18308 backend bck1
18309 mode http
18310
18311 http-request cache-use foobar
18312 http-response cache-store foobar
18313 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
18314
18315 cache foobar
18316 total-max-size 4
18317 max-age 240
18318
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018319/*
18320 * Local variables:
18321 * fill-column: 79
18322 * End:
18323 */